1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
31 #include "blockinput.h"
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #include <sys/types.h>
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
61 #include "character.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget
, XtPointer
, XEvent
*, Boolean
*);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
143 int use_xim
= 0; /* configure --without-xim */
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
151 static int any_help_event_p
;
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window
;
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
159 struct x_display_info
*x_display_list
;
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list
;
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173 extern struct frame
*updating_frame
;
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177 static struct frame
*pending_autoraise_frame
;
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
184 } pending_event_wait
;
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con
;
189 static String Xt_default_resources
[] = {0};
191 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
;
194 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
;
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph
;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame
;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame
;
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar
;
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time
;
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251 static Time last_user_time
;
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
257 static int volatile input_signal_count
;
259 static int input_signal_count
;
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
264 static int x_noop_count
;
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt
, Qhyper
, Qmeta
, Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
;
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms
;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1
;
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file
;
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock
;
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class
[] = EMACS_CLASS
;
284 XEMBED_MAPPED
= 1 << 0
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY
= 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE
= 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE
= 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
= 3,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
= 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT
= 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV
= 7,
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON
= 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF
= 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR
= 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR
= 14
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*, Colormap
, XColor
*);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
309 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame
*);
310 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame
*);
311 static const XColor
*x_color_cells (Display
*, int *);
312 static void x_update_window_end (struct window
*, int, int);
314 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display
*);
315 static struct terminal
*x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*);
316 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*);
317 static void x_update_end (struct frame
*);
318 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*);
319 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*);
320 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*);
321 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame
*);
322 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*, int, int) NO_RETURN
;
323 static void frame_highlight (struct frame
*);
324 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*);
325 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*, struct frame
*);
326 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info
*,
327 struct frame
*, struct input_event
*);
328 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*,
329 XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
330 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*);
331 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*);
332 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*);
333 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int,
334 enum text_cursor_kinds
);
336 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window
*, struct glyph_row
*, int, GC
);
337 static void x_flush (struct frame
*f
);
338 static void x_update_begin (struct frame
*);
339 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window
*);
340 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row
*);
341 static struct scroll_bar
*x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*, Window
);
342 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame
**, Lisp_Object
*,
343 enum scroll_bar_part
*,
344 Lisp_Object
*, Lisp_Object
*,
346 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*, XPropertyEvent
*);
347 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*);
348 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*, int, int);
349 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*, int, int, int);
350 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*, XEvent
*,
351 int *, struct input_event
*);
353 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*, Display
*);
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static void x_connection_closed (Display
*, const char *);
358 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*, int);
359 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*, int);
360 static void x_initialize (void);
363 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
366 x_flush (struct frame
*f
)
368 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
369 connection may be broken. */
370 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay
))
376 Lisp_Object rest
, frame
;
377 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest
, frame
)
378 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame
));
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f
))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
397 /***********************************************************************
399 ***********************************************************************/
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
412 struct record event_record
[100];
414 int event_record_index
;
417 record_event (char *locus
, int type
)
419 if (event_record_index
== sizeof (event_record
) / sizeof (struct record
))
420 event_record_index
= 0;
422 event_record
[event_record_index
].locus
= locus
;
423 event_record
[event_record_index
].type
= type
;
424 event_record_index
++;
431 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
433 struct x_display_info
*
434 x_display_info_for_display (Display
*dpy
)
436 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
438 for (dpyinfo
= x_display_list
; dpyinfo
; dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
)
439 if (dpyinfo
->display
== dpy
)
445 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
448 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame
*f
)
450 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
451 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
452 Window win
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
454 double alpha_min
= 1.0;
457 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
462 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
463 alpha_min
= XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
);
464 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
))
465 alpha_min
= (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit
)) / 100.0;
469 else if (alpha
> 1.0)
471 else if (0.0 <= alpha
&& alpha
< alpha_min
&& alpha_min
<= 1.0)
474 opac
= alpha
* OPAQUE
;
476 /* return unless necessary */
481 unsigned long n
, left
;
483 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
484 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
485 0L, 1L, False
, XA_CARDINAL
,
486 &actual
, &format
, &n
, &left
,
489 if (rc
== Success
&& actual
!= None
)
491 unsigned long value
= *(unsigned long *)data
;
492 XFree ((void *) data
);
501 XChangeProperty (dpy
, win
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
,
502 XA_CARDINAL
, 32, PropModeReplace
,
503 (unsigned char *) &opac
, 1L);
508 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
510 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
514 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
516 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
520 /***********************************************************************
521 Starting and ending an update
522 ***********************************************************************/
524 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
525 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
526 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
527 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
528 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
531 x_update_begin (struct frame
*f
)
537 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
538 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
542 x_update_window_begin (struct window
*w
)
544 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
545 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
548 set_output_cursor (&w
->cursor
);
552 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
554 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
555 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 1;
557 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
559 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f
))
560 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
567 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
570 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window
*w
, int x
, int y0
, int y1
)
572 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
575 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID
);
577 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
580 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
581 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
, x
, y0
, x
, y1
);
584 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
586 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
587 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
589 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
590 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
591 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
593 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
594 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
598 x_update_window_end (struct window
*w
, int cursor_on_p
, int mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
600 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w
->frame
));
602 if (!w
->pseudo_window_p
)
607 display_and_set_cursor (w
, 1, output_cursor
.hpos
,
609 output_cursor
.x
, output_cursor
.y
);
611 if (draw_window_fringes (w
, 1))
612 x_draw_vertical_border (w
);
617 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
618 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
619 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p
)
621 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
622 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
623 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
626 updated_window
= NULL
;
630 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
634 x_update_end (struct frame
*f
)
636 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
637 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
)->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
641 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
647 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
648 complete update has been performed. The global variable
649 updated_window is not available here. */
652 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame
*f
)
656 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (f
);
658 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
659 || f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
662 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
663 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
,
664 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
,
665 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
);
666 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
673 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
674 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
675 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
676 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
677 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
678 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
681 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row
*desired_row
)
683 struct window
*w
= updated_window
;
689 if (!desired_row
->mode_line_p
&& !w
->pseudo_window_p
)
690 desired_row
->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p
= 1;
692 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
693 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
694 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
695 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
696 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
697 overhead is very small. */
698 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
699 && desired_row
->full_width_p
700 && (f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
),
701 width
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
703 && (height
= desired_row
->visible_height
,
706 int y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, desired_row
->y
));
709 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
710 0, y
, width
, height
, False
);
711 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
712 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - width
,
713 y
, width
, height
, False
);
719 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params
*p
)
721 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
722 Display
*display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
723 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
724 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
725 struct face
*face
= p
->face
;
727 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
728 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, -1, gc
);
732 int bx
= p
->bx
, by
= p
->by
, nx
= p
->nx
, ny
= p
->ny
;
734 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
735 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
736 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
737 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
739 XSetFillStyle (display
, face
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
741 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->background
);
743 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
744 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
745 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
746 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
747 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
748 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
749 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
750 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
752 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
756 int bar_area_x
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
757 int bar_area_width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
758 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
762 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
763 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== p
->x
)
764 bx
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
765 else if (p
->x
+ p
->wd
== bar_area_x
)
769 int header_line_height
= WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w
);
771 nx
= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
772 by
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (header_line_height
,
774 ny
= row
->visible_height
;
779 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== bx
)
781 bx
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
782 nx
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
784 else if (bx
+ nx
== bar_area_x
)
785 nx
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
790 if (bx
>= 0 && nx
> 0)
791 XFillRectangle (display
, window
, face
->gc
, bx
, by
, nx
, ny
);
794 XSetForeground (display
, face
->gc
, face
->foreground
);
800 Pixmap pixmap
, clipmask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
801 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
));
805 bits
= (char *) (p
->bits
+ p
->dh
);
807 bits
= (char *) p
->bits
+ p
->dh
;
809 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
811 pixmap
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
, window
, bits
, p
->wd
, p
->h
,
813 ? (p
->overlay_p
? face
->background
814 : f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
816 face
->background
, depth
);
820 clipmask
= XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display
,
821 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
,
824 gcv
.clip_mask
= clipmask
;
825 gcv
.clip_x_origin
= p
->x
;
826 gcv
.clip_y_origin
= p
->y
;
827 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
, &gcv
);
830 XCopyArea (display
, pixmap
, window
, gc
, 0, 0,
831 p
->wd
, p
->h
, p
->x
, p
->y
);
832 XFreePixmap (display
, pixmap
);
836 gcv
.clip_mask
= (Pixmap
) 0;
837 XChangeGC (display
, gc
, GCClipMask
, &gcv
);
838 XFreePixmap (display
, clipmask
);
842 XSetClipMask (display
, gc
, None
);
847 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
848 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
849 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
853 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
857 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
858 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
861 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal
*terminal
)
866 /***********************************************************************
868 ***********************************************************************/
872 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*);
873 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
874 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*,
876 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
877 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
878 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
880 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*, int) NO_RETURN
;
881 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*);
882 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
883 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
884 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*);
885 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*, Display
*, Colormap
,
886 unsigned long *, double, int);
887 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*, struct relief
*,
888 double, int, unsigned long);
889 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*);
890 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*);
891 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*);
892 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*);
893 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*, Pixmap
);
894 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int,
896 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, int, int, int,
899 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*, int, int, int, int,
900 int, int, int, XRectangle
*);
901 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame
*);
904 static void x_check_font (struct frame
*, struct font
*);
908 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
914 if (s
->font
== FRAME_FONT (s
->f
)
915 && s
->face
->background
== FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
916 && s
->face
->foreground
== FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s
->f
)
918 s
->gc
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_gc
;
921 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 xgcv
.background
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
926 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
928 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
929 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
930 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
931 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
932 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
;
933 if (xgcv
.foreground
== xgcv
.background
)
934 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
936 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
937 if (xgcv
.background
== s
->face
->background
938 && xgcv
.foreground
== s
->face
->foreground
)
940 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->foreground
;
941 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->background
;
944 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s
->f
, s
->font
));
945 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
946 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
948 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
949 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
952 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
953 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
955 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
960 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
963 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
968 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
969 face_id
= MOUSE_HL_INFO (s
->f
)->mouse_face_face_id
;
970 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
972 face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, MOUSE_FACE_ID
);
974 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
975 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, s
->first_glyph
->u
.ch
, -1, Qnil
);
977 face_id
= FACE_FOR_CHAR (s
->f
, face
, 0, -1, Qnil
);
978 s
->face
= FACE_FROM_ID (s
->f
, face_id
);
979 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
981 if (s
->font
== s
->face
->font
)
985 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
990 xgcv
.background
= s
->face
->background
;
991 xgcv
.foreground
= s
->face
->foreground
;
992 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
993 mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
995 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
)
996 XChangeGC (s
->display
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
,
999 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
1000 = XCreateGC (s
->display
, s
->window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1002 s
->gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s
->f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
1005 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1009 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1010 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1011 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1014 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1016 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1020 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1021 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1027 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s
->f
, s
->face
);
1029 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT
)
1031 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1032 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1034 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO
)
1036 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s
);
1037 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1039 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
1041 x_set_cursor_gc (s
);
1044 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
)
1046 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
1047 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1049 else if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1050 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
1052 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1053 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1057 s
->gc
= s
->face
->gc
;
1058 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
1061 /* GC must have been set. */
1062 xassert (s
->gc
!= 0);
1066 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1067 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1070 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1072 XRectangle
*r
= s
->clip
;
1073 int n
= get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s
, r
, 2);
1076 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, r
, n
, Unsorted
);
1081 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1082 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string
*src
, struct glyph_string
*dst
)
1091 r
.width
= src
->width
;
1093 r
.height
= src
->height
;
1096 XSetClipRectangles (dst
->display
, dst
->gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
1101 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1104 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1107 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
1108 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
1110 struct font_metrics metrics
;
1112 if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
1114 unsigned *code
= alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s
->nchars
);
1115 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1118 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++)
1119 code
[i
] = (s
->char2b
[i
].byte1
<< 8) | s
->char2b
[i
].byte2
;
1120 font
->driver
->text_extents (font
, code
, s
->nchars
, &metrics
);
1124 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1126 composition_gstring_width (gstring
, s
->cmp_from
, s
->cmp_to
, &metrics
);
1128 s
->right_overhang
= (metrics
.rbearing
> metrics
.width
1129 ? metrics
.rbearing
- metrics
.width
: 0);
1130 s
->left_overhang
= metrics
.lbearing
< 0 ? - metrics
.lbearing
: 0;
1134 s
->right_overhang
= s
->cmp
->rbearing
- s
->cmp
->pixel_width
;
1135 s
->left_overhang
= - s
->cmp
->lbearing
;
1140 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1143 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
1146 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1147 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
1148 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
1149 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
1153 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1154 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1155 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1156 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1157 contains the first component of a composition. */
1160 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string
*s
, int force_p
)
1162 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1163 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1164 if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
1166 int box_line_width
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
1170 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1171 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
1172 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
,
1173 s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1174 s
->background_width
,
1175 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1176 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
1177 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1179 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s
->font
) < s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
1180 || s
->font_not_found_p
1181 || s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1184 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ box_line_width
,
1185 s
->background_width
,
1186 s
->height
- 2 * box_line_width
);
1187 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
1193 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1196 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1200 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1201 of S to the right of that box line. */
1202 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1203 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1204 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1208 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1210 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1212 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; ++i
)
1214 struct glyph
*g
= s
->first_glyph
+ i
;
1215 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
,
1216 s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
, g
->pixel_width
- 1,
1218 x
+= g
->pixel_width
;
1223 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1224 int boff
= font
->baseline_offset
;
1227 if (font
->vertical_centering
)
1228 boff
= VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font
, s
->f
) - boff
;
1230 y
= s
->ybase
- boff
;
1232 || (s
->background_filled_p
&& s
->hl
!= DRAW_CURSOR
))
1233 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 0);
1235 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
, y
, 1);
1236 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1237 font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, s
->nchars
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1241 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1244 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1247 struct font
*font
= s
->font
;
1249 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1250 of S to the right of that box line. */
1251 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1252 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1253 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1257 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1258 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1259 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1260 this composition. */
1262 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1263 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1264 if (s
->font_not_found_p
)
1266 if (s
->cmp_from
== 0)
1267 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, s
->y
,
1268 s
->width
- 1, s
->height
- 1);
1270 else if (! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
)
1274 for (i
= 0, j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, j
++)
1275 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s
->cmp
, j
) != '\t')
1277 int xx
= x
+ s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2];
1278 int yy
= y
- s
->cmp
->offsets
[j
* 2 + 1];
1280 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
, yy
, 0);
1281 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1282 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, j
+ 1, xx
+ 1, yy
, 0);
1287 Lisp_Object gstring
= composition_gstring_from_id (s
->cmp_id
);
1292 for (i
= j
= s
->cmp_from
; i
< s
->cmp_to
; i
++)
1294 glyph
= LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring
, i
);
1295 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph
)))
1296 width
+= LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph
);
1299 int xoff
, yoff
, wadjust
;
1303 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1304 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1305 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1308 xoff
= LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph
);
1309 yoff
= LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph
);
1310 wadjust
= LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph
);
1311 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1312 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1313 font
->driver
->draw (s
, i
, i
+ 1, x
+ xoff
+ 1, y
+ yoff
, 0);
1321 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
, y
, 0);
1322 if (s
->face
->overstrike
)
1323 font
->driver
->draw (s
, j
, i
, x
+ 1, y
, 0);
1329 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1332 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1334 struct glyph
*glyph
= s
->first_glyph
;
1338 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1339 of S to the right of that box line. */
1340 if (s
->face
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
1341 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
)
1342 x
= s
->x
+ eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
1348 for (i
= 0; i
< s
->nchars
; i
++, glyph
++)
1350 char buf
[7], *str
= NULL
;
1351 int len
= glyph
->u
.glyphless
.len
;
1353 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM
)
1356 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display
)
1357 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
))
1361 = (! glyph
->u
.glyphless
.for_no_font
1362 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display
,
1363 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
)
1364 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display
)->extras
[0]);
1365 if (STRINGP (acronym
))
1366 str
= SSDATA (acronym
);
1369 else if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
== GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE
)
1371 sprintf ((char *) buf
, "%0*X",
1372 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
< 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1373 glyph
->u
.glyphless
.ch
);
1379 int upper_len
= (len
+ 1) / 2;
1382 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1383 for (j
= 0; j
< len
; j
++)
1385 code
= s
->font
->driver
->encode_char (s
->font
, str
[j
]);
1386 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b
+ j
, code
>> 8, code
& 0xFF);
1388 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, 0, upper_len
,
1389 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_xoff
,
1390 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.upper_yoff
,
1392 s
->font
->driver
->draw (s
, upper_len
, len
,
1393 x
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_xoff
,
1394 s
->ybase
+ glyph
->slice
.glyphless
.lower_yoff
,
1397 if (glyph
->u
.glyphless
.method
!= GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE
)
1398 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
1399 x
, s
->ybase
- glyph
->ascent
,
1400 glyph
->pixel_width
- 1,
1401 glyph
->ascent
+ glyph
->descent
- 1);
1402 x
+= glyph
->pixel_width
;
1406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1408 static struct frame
*x_frame_of_widget (Widget
);
1409 static Boolean
cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*, XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*,
1410 XrmValue
*, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
*);
1411 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext
, XrmValue
*, XtPointer
,
1412 XrmValue
*, Cardinal
*);
1415 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1416 cannot be determined. */
1418 static struct frame
*
1419 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget
)
1421 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
1425 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget
));
1427 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1428 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1429 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1430 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1431 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget
))
1432 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
1434 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1435 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1436 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
1437 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail
))
1438 && (f
= XFRAME (XCAR (tail
)),
1440 && f
->output_data
.nothing
!= 1
1441 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
))
1442 && f
->output_data
.x
->widget
== widget
)
1449 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1450 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1451 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1452 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1453 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1454 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1457 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
,
1458 unsigned long *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1460 struct frame
*f
= x_frame_of_widget (widget
);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, display
, cmap
, pixel
, factor
, delta
);
1465 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1466 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1468 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args
[] =
1470 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.screen
),
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset
, (XtPointer
) XtOffset (Widget
, core
.colormap
),
1477 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1478 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1480 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1483 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1485 DPY is the display we are working on.
1487 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1488 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1489 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1490 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1492 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1493 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1495 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1496 we allocated the color or not.
1498 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1501 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display
*dpy
, XrmValue
*args
, Cardinal
*nargs
,
1502 XrmValue
*from
, XrmValue
*to
,
1503 XtPointer
*closure_ret
)
1513 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1514 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1516 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL
, NULL
);
1520 screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1521 cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1522 color_name
= (String
) from
->addr
;
1524 if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultBackground
) == 0)
1526 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1527 pixel
= WhitePixelOfScreen (screen
);
1529 else if (strcmp (color_name
, XtDefaultForeground
) == 0)
1531 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) False
;
1532 pixel
= BlackPixelOfScreen (screen
);
1534 else if (XParseColor (dpy
, cmap
, color_name
, &color
)
1535 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy
, cmap
, &color
))
1537 pixel
= color
.pixel
;
1538 *closure_ret
= (XtPointer
) True
;
1543 Cardinal nparams
= 1;
1545 params
[0] = color_name
;
1546 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy
),
1547 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1548 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1553 if (to
->addr
!= NULL
)
1555 if (to
->size
< sizeof (Pixel
))
1557 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1561 *(Pixel
*) to
->addr
= pixel
;
1565 cvt_string_to_pixel_value
= pixel
;
1566 to
->addr
= (XtPointer
) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value
;
1569 to
->size
= sizeof (Pixel
);
1574 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1575 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1576 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1578 APP is the application context in which we work.
1580 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1581 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1582 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1584 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1587 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app
, XrmValuePtr to
, XtPointer closure
, XrmValuePtr args
,
1592 XtAppWarningMsg (app
, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1594 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1597 else if (closure
!= NULL
)
1599 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1600 Screen
*screen
= *(Screen
**) args
[0].addr
;
1601 Colormap cmap
= *(Colormap
*) args
[1].addr
;
1602 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen
), screen
, cmap
,
1603 (Pixel
*) to
->addr
, 1);
1608 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1611 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1612 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1613 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1614 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1616 static const XColor
*
1617 x_color_cells (Display
*dpy
, int *ncells
)
1619 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1621 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
== NULL
)
1623 Screen
*screen
= dpyinfo
->screen
;
1626 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1627 = XDisplayCells (dpy
, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen
));
1628 dpyinfo
->color_cells
1629 = (XColor
*) xmalloc (dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
1630 * sizeof *dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1632 for (i
= 0; i
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
; ++i
)
1633 dpyinfo
->color_cells
[i
].pixel
= i
;
1635 XQueryColors (dpy
, dpyinfo
->cmap
,
1636 dpyinfo
->color_cells
, dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1639 *ncells
= dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
;
1640 return dpyinfo
->color_cells
;
1644 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1645 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1648 x_query_colors (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*colors
, int ncolors
)
1650 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1652 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
)
1655 for (i
= 0; i
< ncolors
; ++i
)
1657 unsigned long pixel
= colors
[i
].pixel
;
1658 xassert (pixel
< dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
);
1659 xassert (dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
].pixel
== pixel
);
1660 colors
[i
] = dpyinfo
->color_cells
[pixel
];
1664 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), colors
, ncolors
);
1668 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1669 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1672 x_query_color (struct frame
*f
, XColor
*color
)
1674 x_query_colors (f
, color
, 1);
1678 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1679 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1680 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1684 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display
*dpy
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1688 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1691 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1692 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1693 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1694 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1696 unsigned long nearest_delta
= ~ (unsigned long) 0;
1698 const XColor
*cells
= x_color_cells (dpy
, &ncells
);
1700 for (nearest
= i
= 0; i
< ncells
; ++i
)
1702 long dred
= (color
->red
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].red
>> 8);
1703 long dgreen
= (color
->green
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].green
>> 8);
1704 long dblue
= (color
->blue
>> 8) - (cells
[i
].blue
>> 8);
1705 unsigned long delta
= dred
* dred
+ dgreen
* dgreen
+ dblue
* dblue
;
1707 if (delta
< nearest_delta
)
1710 nearest_delta
= delta
;
1714 color
->red
= cells
[nearest
].red
;
1715 color
->green
= cells
[nearest
].green
;
1716 color
->blue
= cells
[nearest
].blue
;
1717 rc
= XAllocColor (dpy
, cmap
, color
);
1721 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1722 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1723 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1724 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
1725 XColor
*cached_color
;
1727 if (dpyinfo
->color_cells
1728 && (cached_color
= &dpyinfo
->color_cells
[color
->pixel
],
1729 (cached_color
->red
!= color
->red
1730 || cached_color
->blue
!= color
->blue
1731 || cached_color
->green
!= color
->green
)))
1733 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
1734 dpyinfo
->color_cells
= NULL
;
1735 dpyinfo
->ncolor_cells
= 0;
1739 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1741 register_color (color
->pixel
);
1742 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1748 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1749 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1750 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1754 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame
*f
, Colormap cmap
, XColor
*color
)
1756 gamma_correct (f
, color
);
1757 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), cmap
, color
);
1761 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1762 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1763 get color reference counts right. */
1766 x_copy_color (struct frame
*f
, long unsigned int pixel
)
1770 color
.pixel
= pixel
;
1772 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1773 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
), &color
);
1775 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1776 register_color (pixel
);
1782 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1785 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1786 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1787 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1788 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1789 use an additional additive factor.
1791 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1792 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1793 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1796 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1797 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1798 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1799 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1800 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1801 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1804 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame
*f
, Display
*display
, Colormap cmap
, long unsigned int *pixel
, double factor
, int delta
)
1810 /* Get RGB color values. */
1811 color
.pixel
= *pixel
;
1812 x_query_color (f
, &color
);
1814 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1815 xassert (factor
>= 0);
1816 new.red
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.red
);
1817 new.green
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.green
);
1818 new.blue
= min (0xffff, factor
* color
.blue
);
1820 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1821 bright
= (2 * color
.red
+ 3 * color
.green
+ color
.blue
) / 6;
1823 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1824 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1825 if (bright
< HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
)
1826 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1827 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1829 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1830 double dimness
= 1 - (double)bright
/ HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT
;
1831 /* The additive adjustment. */
1832 int min_delta
= delta
* dimness
* factor
/ 2;
1836 new.red
= max (0, new.red
- min_delta
);
1837 new.green
= max (0, new.green
- min_delta
);
1838 new.blue
= max (0, new.blue
- min_delta
);
1842 new.red
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.red
);
1843 new.green
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.green
);
1844 new.blue
= min (0xffff, min_delta
+ new.blue
);
1848 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1849 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1852 if (new.pixel
== *pixel
)
1854 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1855 delta to the RGB values. */
1856 x_free_colors (f
, &new.pixel
, 1);
1858 new.red
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.red
);
1859 new.green
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.green
);
1860 new.blue
= min (0xffff, delta
+ color
.blue
);
1861 success_p
= x_alloc_nearest_color (f
, cmap
, &new);
1872 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1873 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1874 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1875 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1876 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1877 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1880 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame
*f
, struct relief
*relief
, double factor
, int delta
, long unsigned int default_pixel
)
1883 struct x_output
*di
= f
->output_data
.x
;
1884 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCLineWidth
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
1885 unsigned long pixel
;
1886 unsigned long background
= di
->relief_background
;
1887 Colormap cmap
= FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
);
1888 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
1889 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1891 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= False
;
1892 xgcv
.line_width
= 1;
1894 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1895 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1896 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1898 && relief
->allocated_p
)
1900 x_free_colors (f
, &relief
->pixel
, 1);
1901 relief
->allocated_p
= 0;
1904 /* Allocate new color. */
1905 xgcv
.foreground
= default_pixel
;
1907 if (dpyinfo
->n_planes
!= 1
1908 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, dpy
, cmap
, &pixel
, factor
, delta
))
1910 relief
->allocated_p
= 1;
1911 xgcv
.foreground
= relief
->pixel
= pixel
;
1914 if (relief
->gc
== 0)
1916 xgcv
.stipple
= dpyinfo
->gray
;
1918 relief
->gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), mask
, &xgcv
);
1921 XChangeGC (dpy
, relief
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
1925 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1928 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string
*s
)
1930 struct x_output
*di
= s
->f
->output_data
.x
;
1931 unsigned long color
;
1933 if (s
->face
->use_box_color_for_shadows_p
)
1934 color
= s
->face
->box_color
;
1935 else if (s
->first_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
1937 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0))
1938 color
= IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s
->img
, s
->f
, 0);
1943 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1944 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
1945 color
= xgcv
.background
;
1948 if (di
->white_relief
.gc
== 0
1949 || color
!= di
->relief_background
)
1951 di
->relief_background
= color
;
1952 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->white_relief
, 1.2, 0x8000,
1953 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1954 x_setup_relief_color (s
->f
, &di
->black_relief
, 0.6, 0x4000,
1955 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s
->f
));
1960 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1961 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1962 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1963 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1964 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1965 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1969 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame
*f
,
1970 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
1971 int raised_p
, int top_p
, int bot_p
, int left_p
, int right_p
,
1972 XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
1974 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
1975 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
1980 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
1982 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
1983 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
1985 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1986 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1987 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1994 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
1995 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
1996 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
1998 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
1999 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2000 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, top_y
+ i
,
2001 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, top_y
+ i
);
2008 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
2010 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2011 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, left_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2013 for (i
= (width
> 1 ? 1 : 0); i
< width
; ++i
)
2014 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2015 left_x
+ i
, top_y
+ i
, left_x
+ i
, bottom_y
- i
+ 1);
2018 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2020 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.gc
;
2022 gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.gc
;
2023 XSetClipRectangles (dpy
, gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2027 /* Outermost top line. */
2029 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2030 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), top_y
,
2031 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), top_y
);
2033 /* Outermost left line. */
2035 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
, left_x
, top_y
+ 1, left_x
, bottom_y
);
2041 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2042 left_x
+ (left_p
? 1 : 0), bottom_y
,
2043 right_x
+ (right_p
? 0 : 1), bottom_y
);
2044 for (i
= 1; i
< width
; ++i
)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2046 left_x
+ i
* left_p
, bottom_y
- i
,
2047 right_x
+ 1 - i
* right_p
, bottom_y
- i
);
2053 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, top_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2054 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, right_x
, bottom_y
, 1, 1, False
);
2055 for (i
= 0; i
< width
; ++i
)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy
, window
, gc
,
2057 right_x
- i
, top_y
+ i
+ 1, right_x
- i
, bottom_y
- i
);
2060 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
2064 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2065 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2066 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2067 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2068 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2069 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2072 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
,
2073 int left_x
, int top_y
, int right_x
, int bottom_y
, int width
,
2074 int left_p
, int right_p
, XRectangle
*clip_rect
)
2078 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2079 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->box_color
);
2080 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0, clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
2083 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2084 left_x
, top_y
, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2088 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2089 left_x
, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2092 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2093 left_x
, bottom_y
- width
+ 1, right_x
- left_x
+ 1, width
);
2097 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2098 right_x
- width
+ 1, top_y
, width
, bottom_y
- top_y
+ 1);
2100 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2101 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2105 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2108 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2110 int width
, left_x
, right_x
, top_y
, bottom_y
, last_x
, raised_p
;
2111 int left_p
, right_p
;
2112 struct glyph
*last_glyph
;
2113 XRectangle clip_rect
;
2115 last_x
= ((s
->row
->full_width_p
&& !s
->w
->pseudo_window_p
)
2116 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s
->w
)
2117 : window_box_right (s
->w
, s
->area
));
2119 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2120 last_glyph
= (s
->cmp
|| s
->img
2122 : s
->first_glyph
+ s
->nchars
- 1);
2124 width
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2125 raised_p
= s
->face
->box
== FACE_RAISED_BOX
;
2127 right_x
= (s
->row
->full_width_p
&& s
->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2129 : min (last_x
, s
->x
+ s
->background_width
) - 1);
2131 bottom_y
= top_y
+ s
->height
- 1;
2133 left_p
= (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2134 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2136 || s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2137 right_p
= (last_glyph
->right_box_line_p
2138 || (s
->hl
== DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2140 || s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
)));
2142 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2144 if (s
->face
->box
== FACE_SIMPLE_BOX
)
2145 x_draw_box_rect (s
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
, width
,
2146 left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2149 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2150 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, left_x
, top_y
, right_x
, bottom_y
,
2151 width
, raised_p
, 1, 1, left_p
, right_p
, &clip_rect
);
2156 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2159 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2162 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2164 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2165 right of that line. */
2166 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2167 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2169 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2171 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2173 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2174 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2175 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2176 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2182 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2183 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2184 trust on the shape extension to be available
2185 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2187 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2190 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2192 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2193 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
;
2194 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
;
2195 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2196 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2198 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2201 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2202 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2203 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2204 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2205 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2206 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2210 XRectangle clip_rect
, image_rect
, r
;
2212 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &clip_rect
);
2215 image_rect
.width
= s
->slice
.width
;
2216 image_rect
.height
= s
->slice
.height
;
2217 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect
, &image_rect
, &r
))
2218 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2219 s
->slice
.x
+ r
.x
- x
, s
->slice
.y
+ r
.y
- y
,
2220 r
.width
, r
.height
, r
.x
, r
.y
);
2222 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2223 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2224 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2225 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2226 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2227 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2228 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2230 int relief
= s
->img
->relief
;
2231 if (relief
< 0) relief
= -relief
;
2232 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2233 x
- relief
, y
- relief
,
2234 s
->slice
.width
+ relief
*2 - 1,
2235 s
->slice
.height
+ relief
*2 - 1);
2240 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2241 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2242 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2246 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2249 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2251 int x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
, extra
;
2254 int y
= s
->ybase
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2256 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2257 right of that line. */
2258 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2259 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2261 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2263 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2265 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2266 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2267 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2268 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2270 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2271 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
)
2273 thick
= tool_bar_button_relief
>= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief
: DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF
;
2274 raised_p
= s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
;
2278 thick
= eabs (s
->img
->relief
);
2279 raised_p
= s
->img
->relief
> 0;
2282 extra
= s
->face
->id
== TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2283 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin
) : 0;
2285 x0
= x
- thick
- extra
;
2286 y0
= y
- thick
- extra
;
2287 x1
= x
+ s
->slice
.width
+ thick
- 1 + extra
;
2288 y1
= y
+ s
->slice
.height
+ thick
- 1 + extra
;
2290 x_setup_relief_colors (s
);
2291 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2292 x_draw_relief_rect (s
->f
, x0
, y0
, x1
, y1
, thick
, raised_p
,
2294 s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
== s
->img
->height
,
2296 s
->slice
.x
+ s
->slice
.width
== s
->img
->width
,
2301 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2304 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string
*s
, Pixmap pixmap
)
2307 int y
= s
->ybase
- s
->y
- image_ascent (s
->img
, s
->face
, &s
->slice
);
2309 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2310 right of that line. */
2311 if (s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2312 && s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2314 x
+= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2316 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2318 if (s
->slice
.x
== 0)
2319 x
+= s
->img
->hmargin
;
2320 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2321 y
+= s
->img
->vmargin
;
2327 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2328 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2329 trust on the shape extension to be available
2330 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2332 unsigned long mask
= (GCClipMask
| GCClipXOrigin
| GCClipYOrigin
2336 xgcv
.clip_mask
= s
->img
->mask
;
2337 xgcv
.clip_x_origin
= x
- s
->slice
.x
;
2338 xgcv
.clip_y_origin
= y
- s
->slice
.y
;
2339 xgcv
.function
= GXcopy
;
2340 XChangeGC (s
->display
, s
->gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
2342 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2343 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2344 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2345 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2349 XCopyArea (s
->display
, s
->img
->pixmap
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2350 s
->slice
.x
, s
->slice
.y
,
2351 s
->slice
.width
, s
->slice
.height
, x
, y
);
2353 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2354 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2355 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2356 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2357 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2358 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2359 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
)
2361 int r
= s
->img
->relief
;
2363 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
- r
, y
- r
,
2364 s
->slice
.width
+ r
*2 - 1,
2365 s
->slice
.height
+ r
*2 - 1);
2370 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2371 XDrawRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
, x
, y
,
2372 s
->slice
.width
- 1, s
->slice
.height
- 1);
2376 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2377 give the rectangle to draw. */
2380 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string
*s
, int x
, int y
, int w
, int h
)
2384 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2385 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2386 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2387 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2390 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2394 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2397 s->x +-------------------------
2400 | +-------------------------
2403 | | +-------------------
2409 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2411 int box_line_hwidth
= eabs (s
->face
->box_line_width
);
2412 int box_line_vwidth
= max (s
->face
->box_line_width
, 0);
2414 Pixmap pixmap
= None
;
2417 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2418 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2419 if (s
->slice
.y
+ s
->slice
.height
>= s
->img
->height
)
2420 height
-= box_line_vwidth
;
2422 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2423 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2425 s
->stippled_p
= s
->face
->stipple
!= 0;
2426 if (height
> s
->slice
.height
2430 || s
->img
->pixmap
== 0
2431 || s
->width
!= s
->background_width
)
2435 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2436 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2437 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2438 Screen
*screen
= FRAME_X_SCREEN (s
->f
);
2439 int depth
= DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen
);
2441 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2442 pixmap
= XCreatePixmap (s
->display
, s
->window
,
2443 s
->background_width
,
2446 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2448 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2450 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2453 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2454 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2455 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, - s
->x
, - s
->y
);
2456 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2457 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2458 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, s
->gc
, FillSolid
);
2459 XSetTSOrigin (s
->display
, s
->gc
, 0, 0);
2464 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
,
2466 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2467 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->gc
,
2468 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
);
2469 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2477 if (s
->first_glyph
->left_box_line_p
2479 x
+= box_line_hwidth
;
2481 if (s
->slice
.y
== 0)
2482 y
+= box_line_vwidth
;
2484 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, y
, s
->background_width
, height
);
2487 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2490 /* Draw the foreground. */
2493 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s
, pixmap
);
2494 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2495 XCopyArea (s
->display
, pixmap
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2496 0, 0, s
->background_width
, s
->height
, s
->x
, s
->y
);
2497 XFreePixmap (s
->display
, pixmap
);
2500 x_draw_image_foreground (s
);
2502 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2504 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2505 || s
->hl
== DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
)
2506 x_draw_image_relief (s
);
2510 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2513 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2515 xassert (s
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
);
2517 if (s
->hl
== DRAW_CURSOR
2518 && !x_stretch_cursor_p
)
2520 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2521 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2522 int width
, background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2525 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2527 int left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2531 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2537 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2539 int right_x
= window_box_right_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2541 if (x
+ background_width
> right_x
)
2542 background_width
-= x
- right_x
;
2543 x
+= background_width
;
2545 width
= min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s
->f
), background_width
);
2546 if (s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, width
, s
->height
);
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width
< background_width
)
2556 int w
= background_width
- width
, h
= s
->height
;
2560 if (!s
->row
->reversed_p
)
2564 if (s
->row
->mouse_face_p
2565 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s
->w
))
2567 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s
);
2573 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s
, &r
);
2574 XSetClipRectangles (s
->display
, gc
, 0, 0, &r
, 1, Unsorted
);
2576 if (s
->face
->stipple
)
2578 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2579 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillOpaqueStippled
);
2580 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2581 XSetFillStyle (s
->display
, gc
, FillSolid
);
2586 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, gc
, GCForeground
| GCBackground
, &xgcv
);
2587 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.background
);
2588 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, gc
, x
, y
, w
, h
);
2589 XSetForeground (s
->display
, gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2593 else if (!s
->background_filled_p
)
2595 int background_width
= s
->background_width
;
2596 int x
= s
->x
, left_x
= window_box_left_offset (s
->w
, TEXT_AREA
);
2598 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2599 except for header line and mode line. */
2600 if (x
< left_x
&& !s
->row
->mode_line_p
)
2602 background_width
-= left_x
- x
;
2605 if (background_width
> 0)
2606 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s
, x
, s
->y
, background_width
, s
->height
);
2609 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2613 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2616 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string
*s
)
2618 int relief_drawn_p
= 0;
2620 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2621 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2622 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2623 if (s
->next
&& s
->right_overhang
&& !s
->for_overlaps
)
2626 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2628 for (width
= 0, next
= s
->next
;
2629 next
&& width
< s
->right_overhang
;
2630 width
+= next
->width
, next
= next
->next
)
2631 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
!= IMAGE_GLYPH
)
2633 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next
);
2635 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== STRETCH_GLYPH
)
2636 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next
);
2638 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next
, 1);
2639 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2643 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2644 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s
);
2646 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2647 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2648 if (!s
->for_overlaps
2649 && s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
2650 && (s
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
2651 || s
->first_glyph
->type
== COMPOSITE_GLYPH
))
2654 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2655 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2656 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2657 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2660 else if (!s
->clip_head
/* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2662 && ((s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->left_overhang
)
2663 || (s
->next
&& s
->next
->hl
!= s
->hl
&& s
->right_overhang
)))
2664 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2665 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2666 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, s
);
2669 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s
);
2671 switch (s
->first_glyph
->type
)
2674 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s
);
2678 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s
);
2682 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2683 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2685 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 0);
2686 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2689 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH
:
2690 if (s
->for_overlaps
|| (s
->cmp_from
> 0
2691 && ! s
->first_glyph
->u
.cmp
.automatic
))
2692 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2694 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2695 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2698 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH
:
2699 if (s
->for_overlaps
)
2700 s
->background_filled_p
= 1;
2702 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s
, 1);
2703 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s
);
2710 if (!s
->for_overlaps
)
2712 /* Draw underline. */
2713 if (s
->face
->underline_p
)
2715 unsigned long thickness
, position
;
2718 if (s
->prev
&& s
->prev
->face
->underline_p
)
2720 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2721 thickness
= s
->prev
->underline_thickness
;
2722 position
= s
->prev
->underline_position
;
2726 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2727 if (s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_thickness
> 0)
2728 thickness
= s
->font
->underline_thickness
;
2731 if (x_underline_at_descent_line
)
2732 position
= (s
->height
- thickness
) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2735 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2736 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2737 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2738 specs, and its default is
2740 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2741 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2743 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2744 && s
->font
&& s
->font
->underline_position
>= 0)
2745 position
= s
->font
->underline_position
;
2747 position
= (s
->font
->descent
+ 1) / 2;
2749 position
= underline_minimum_offset
;
2751 position
= max (position
, underline_minimum_offset
);
2753 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2754 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2755 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
<= s
->ybase
+ position
)
2756 position
= (s
->height
- 1) - (s
->ybase
- s
->y
);
2757 if (s
->y
+ s
->height
< s
->ybase
+ position
+ thickness
)
2758 thickness
= (s
->y
+ s
->height
) - (s
->ybase
+ position
);
2759 s
->underline_thickness
= thickness
;
2760 s
->underline_position
= position
;
2761 y
= s
->ybase
+ position
;
2762 if (s
->face
->underline_defaulted_p
)
2763 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2764 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2768 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2769 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->underline_color
);
2770 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
,
2771 s
->x
, y
, s
->width
, thickness
);
2772 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2776 /* Draw overline. */
2777 if (s
->face
->overline_p
)
2779 unsigned long dy
= 0, h
= 1;
2781 if (s
->face
->overline_color_defaulted_p
)
2782 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2787 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2788 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->overline_color
);
2789 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2791 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2795 /* Draw strike-through. */
2796 if (s
->face
->strike_through_p
)
2798 unsigned long h
= 1;
2799 unsigned long dy
= (s
->height
- h
) / 2;
2801 if (s
->face
->strike_through_color_defaulted_p
)
2802 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2807 XGetGCValues (s
->display
, s
->gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
2808 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, s
->face
->strike_through_color
);
2809 XFillRectangle (s
->display
, s
->window
, s
->gc
, s
->x
, s
->y
+ dy
,
2811 XSetForeground (s
->display
, s
->gc
, xgcv
.foreground
);
2815 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2816 if (!relief_drawn_p
&& s
->face
->box
!= FACE_NO_BOX
)
2817 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s
);
2821 struct glyph_string
*prev
;
2823 for (prev
= s
->prev
; prev
; prev
= prev
->prev
)
2824 if (prev
->hl
!= s
->hl
2825 && prev
->x
+ prev
->width
+ prev
->right_overhang
> s
->x
)
2827 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2828 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2829 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= prev
->hl
;
2832 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev
);
2833 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, prev
);
2834 if (prev
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2835 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2837 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev
);
2838 XSetClipMask (prev
->display
, prev
->gc
, None
);
2840 prev
->num_clips
= 0;
2846 struct glyph_string
*next
;
2848 for (next
= s
->next
; next
; next
= next
->next
)
2849 if (next
->hl
!= s
->hl
2850 && next
->x
- next
->left_overhang
< s
->x
+ s
->width
)
2852 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2853 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2854 enum draw_glyphs_face save
= next
->hl
;
2857 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next
);
2858 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s
, next
);
2859 if (next
->first_glyph
->type
== CHAR_GLYPH
)
2860 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2862 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next
);
2863 XSetClipMask (next
->display
, next
->gc
, None
);
2865 next
->num_clips
= 0;
2870 /* Reset clipping. */
2871 XSetClipMask (s
->display
, s
->gc
, None
);
2875 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2878 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int shift_by
)
2880 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
2881 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
2882 x
, y
, width
, height
,
2886 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2890 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame
*f
, register int n
)
2896 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2897 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2900 x_clear_area (Display
*dpy
, Window window
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
, int exposures
)
2902 xassert (width
> 0 && height
> 0);
2903 XClearArea (dpy
, window
, x
, y
, width
, height
, exposures
);
2907 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2910 x_clear_frame (struct frame
*f
)
2912 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2914 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f
)));
2915 output_cursor
.hpos
= output_cursor
.vpos
= 0;
2916 output_cursor
.x
= -1;
2918 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2919 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2922 /* The following call is commented out because it does not seem to accomplish
2923 anything, apart from causing flickering during window resize. */
2924 /* XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f)); */
2926 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2927 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2928 x_scroll_bar_clear (f
);
2930 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2931 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2932 redisplay, do it here. */
2933 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
2934 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2937 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
2944 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2946 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2947 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2949 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2952 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2953 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2956 timeval_subtract (struct timeval
*result
, struct timeval x
, struct timeval y
)
2958 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2959 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2960 if (x
.tv_usec
< y
.tv_usec
)
2962 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000 + 1;
2963 y
.tv_usec
-= 1000000 * nsec
;
2967 if (x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
> 1000000)
2969 int nsec
= (y
.tv_usec
- x
.tv_usec
) / 1000000;
2970 y
.tv_usec
+= 1000000 * nsec
;
2974 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2976 result
->tv_sec
= x
.tv_sec
- y
.tv_sec
;
2977 result
->tv_usec
= x
.tv_usec
- y
.tv_usec
;
2979 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2981 return x
.tv_sec
< y
.tv_sec
;
2985 XTflash (struct frame
*f
)
2991 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2992 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2993 GdkWindow
*window
= gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
2995 cairo_t
*cr
= gdk_cairo_create (window
);
2996 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr
, 1, 1, 1);
2997 cairo_set_operator (cr
, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE
);
2998 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3000 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3004 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3007 vals
.foreground
.pixel
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3008 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3009 vals
.function
= GDK_XOR
;
3010 gc
= gdk_gc_new_with_values (window
,
3011 &vals
, GDK_GC_FUNCTION
| GDK_GC_FOREGROUND
);
3012 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3013 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3014 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3015 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3018 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3019 pixels into background pixels. */
3023 values
.function
= GXxor
;
3024 values
.foreground
= (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
)
3025 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
3027 gc
= XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3028 GCFunction
| GCForeground
, &values
);
3032 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3033 int height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, FRAME_LINES (f
));
3034 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3035 int flash_height
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
3036 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3037 int flash_left
= FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3038 int flash_right
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
);
3042 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3043 edge it is next to. */
3044 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f
))
3046 case vertical_scroll_bar_left
:
3047 flash_left
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3050 case vertical_scroll_bar_right
:
3051 flash_right
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
3058 width
= flash_right
- flash_left
;
3060 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3061 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3063 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3065 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3066 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3067 width
, flash_height
);
3068 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3070 (height
- flash_height
3071 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3072 width
, flash_height
);
3076 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3077 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3078 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3079 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3084 struct timeval wakeup
;
3086 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup
);
3088 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3089 wakeup
.tv_usec
+= 150000;
3090 wakeup
.tv_sec
+= (wakeup
.tv_usec
/ 1000000);
3091 wakeup
.tv_usec
%= 1000000;
3093 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3095 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3097 struct timeval current
;
3098 struct timeval timeout
;
3100 EMACS_GET_TIME (current
);
3102 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3103 if (timeval_subtract (¤t
, wakeup
, current
))
3106 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3108 timeout
.tv_usec
= 10000;
3110 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3111 select (0, NULL
, NULL
, NULL
, &timeout
);
3115 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3116 if (height
> 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
))
3118 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3120 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)
3121 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f
)),
3122 width
, flash_height
);
3123 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3125 (height
- flash_height
3126 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
)),
3127 width
, flash_height
);
3130 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3131 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
,
3132 flash_left
, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
),
3133 width
, height
- 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f
));
3139 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc
));
3141 #undef XFillRectangle
3143 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
);
3152 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3156 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f
, int invisible
)
3161 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
!= 0)
3162 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3163 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->invisible_cursor
);
3166 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3167 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
);
3168 f
->pointer_invisible
= invisible
;
3173 /* Make audible bell. */
3176 XTring_bell (struct frame
*f
)
3178 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))
3180 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3187 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), 0);
3188 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
3195 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3196 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3197 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3198 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3201 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame
*f
, int n
)
3203 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3208 /***********************************************************************
3210 ***********************************************************************/
3212 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3213 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3216 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame
*f
, int vpos
, int n
)
3222 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3225 x_scroll_run (struct window
*w
, struct run
*run
)
3227 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
3228 int x
, y
, width
, height
, from_y
, to_y
, bottom_y
;
3230 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3231 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3233 window_box (w
, -1, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
);
3235 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3236 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3237 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3238 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3239 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
3240 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
3241 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
3242 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
)))
3244 int sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
3248 int bar_area_x
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
3249 int bar_area_width
= (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
)
3250 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
3252 if (bar_area_x
+ bar_area_width
== x
)
3254 x
= bar_area_x
+ sb_width
;
3255 width
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
3257 else if (x
+ width
== bar_area_x
)
3258 width
+= bar_area_width
- sb_width
;
3263 from_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->current_y
);
3264 to_y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, run
->desired_y
);
3265 bottom_y
= y
+ height
;
3269 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3270 line at the bottom. */
3271 if (from_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3272 height
= bottom_y
- from_y
;
3274 height
= run
->height
;
3278 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3280 if (to_y
+ run
->height
> bottom_y
)
3281 height
= bottom_y
- to_y
;
3283 height
= run
->height
;
3288 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3292 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
3293 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3294 f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
,
3304 /***********************************************************************
3306 ***********************************************************************/
3310 frame_highlight (struct frame
*f
)
3312 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3313 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3314 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3315 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3317 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3318 f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
3320 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3321 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3325 frame_unhighlight (struct frame
*f
)
3327 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3328 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3329 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3330 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3332 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
3333 f
->output_data
.x
->border_tile
);
3335 x_update_cursor (f
, 1);
3336 x_set_frame_alpha (f
);
3339 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3340 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3341 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3342 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3343 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3346 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
)
3348 struct frame
*old_focus
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3350 if (frame
!= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3352 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3353 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3354 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= frame
;
3356 if (old_focus
&& old_focus
->auto_lower
)
3357 x_lower_frame (old_focus
);
3359 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
&& dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
->auto_raise
)
3360 pending_autoraise_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3362 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
3365 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo
);
3368 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3369 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3370 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3373 x_focus_changed (int type
, int state
, struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, struct frame
*frame
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3375 if (type
== FocusIn
)
3377 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
!= frame
)
3379 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, frame
);
3380 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= frame
;
3382 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3383 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3384 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame
)
3385 && CONSP (Vframe_list
)
3386 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
3388 bufp
->kind
= FOCUS_IN_EVENT
;
3389 XSETFRAME (bufp
->frame_or_window
, frame
);
3393 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
|= state
;
3396 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3397 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3400 else if (type
== FocusOut
)
3402 frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
&= ~state
;
3404 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
== frame
)
3406 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
3407 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, 0);
3411 if (FRAME_XIC (frame
))
3412 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame
));
3414 if (frame
->pointer_invisible
)
3415 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame
, 0);
3419 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3420 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3422 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3425 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*bufp
)
3427 struct frame
*frame
;
3429 frame
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
->xany
.window
);
3433 switch (event
->type
)
3438 struct frame
*focus_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
;
3440 = focus_frame
? focus_frame
->output_data
.x
->focus_state
: 0;
3442 if (event
->xcrossing
.detail
!= NotifyInferior
3443 && event
->xcrossing
.focus
3444 && ! (focus_state
& FOCUS_EXPLICIT
))
3445 x_focus_changed ((event
->type
== EnterNotify
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3447 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3453 x_focus_changed (event
->type
,
3454 (event
->xfocus
.detail
== NotifyPointer
?
3455 FOCUS_IMPLICIT
: FOCUS_EXPLICIT
),
3456 dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3460 if (event
->xclient
.message_type
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
3462 enum xembed_message msg
= event
->xclient
.data
.l
[1];
3463 x_focus_changed ((msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
? FocusIn
: FocusOut
),
3464 FOCUS_EXPLICIT
, dpyinfo
, frame
, bufp
);
3471 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3472 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3475 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3477 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo
, dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
);
3481 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3482 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3483 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3485 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3486 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3487 the appropriate X display info. */
3490 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame
*frame
)
3492 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame
));
3496 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3498 struct frame
*old_highlight
= dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
;
3500 if (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
3502 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
3503 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)))
3504 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
))
3505 : dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
);
3506 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
))
3508 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
) = Qnil
;
3509 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
;
3513 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
3515 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
!= old_highlight
)
3518 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight
);
3519 if (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
3520 frame_highlight (dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
);
3526 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3528 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3530 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
3532 int min_code
, max_code
;
3535 XModifierKeymap
*mods
;
3537 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= 0;
3538 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= 0;
3539 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3540 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
= 0;
3541 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
= 0;
3543 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo
->display
, &min_code
, &max_code
);
3545 syms
= XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo
->display
,
3546 min_code
, max_code
- min_code
+ 1,
3548 mods
= XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo
->display
);
3550 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3551 Alt keysyms are on. */
3553 int row
, col
; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3554 int found_alt_or_meta
;
3556 for (row
= 3; row
< 8; row
++)
3558 found_alt_or_meta
= 0;
3559 for (col
= 0; col
< mods
->max_keypermod
; col
++)
3561 KeyCode code
= mods
->modifiermap
[(row
* mods
->max_keypermod
) + col
];
3563 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3567 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3571 for (code_col
= 0; code_col
< syms_per_code
; code_col
++)
3573 int sym
= syms
[((code
- min_code
) * syms_per_code
) + code_col
];
3579 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3580 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3585 found_alt_or_meta
= 1;
3586 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3591 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3592 dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3593 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3594 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3599 if (!found_alt_or_meta
)
3600 dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
|= (1 << row
);
3601 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3602 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3606 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3607 if (!found_alt_or_meta
&& ((1 << row
) == LockMask
))
3608 dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
= LockMask
;
3609 code_col
= syms_per_code
;
3610 col
= mods
->max_keypermod
;
3619 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3620 if (! dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3622 dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
= dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
;
3623 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
= 0;
3626 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3627 make them just meta, not alt. */
3628 if (dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
3630 dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
&= ~dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
;
3633 XFree ((char *) syms
);
3634 XFreeModifiermap (mods
);
3637 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3641 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, unsigned int state
)
3643 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3644 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3645 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3646 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3649 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3650 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3651 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3652 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3653 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3654 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3655 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3656 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3659 return ( ((state
& (ShiftMask
| dpyinfo
->shift_lock_mask
)) ? shift_modifier
: 0)
3660 | ((state
& ControlMask
) ? ctrl_modifier
: 0)
3661 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
) ? mod_meta
: 0)
3662 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
) ? mod_alt
: 0)
3663 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
) ? mod_super
: 0)
3664 | ((state
& dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
) ? mod_hyper
: 0));
3668 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, unsigned int state
)
3670 EMACS_UINT mod_meta
= meta_modifier
;
3671 EMACS_UINT mod_alt
= alt_modifier
;
3672 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper
= hyper_modifier
;
3673 EMACS_UINT mod_super
= super_modifier
;
3677 tem
= Fget (Vx_alt_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3678 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_alt
= XUINT (tem
);
3679 tem
= Fget (Vx_meta_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3680 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_meta
= XUINT (tem
);
3681 tem
= Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3682 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_hyper
= XUINT (tem
);
3683 tem
= Fget (Vx_super_keysym
, Qmodifier_value
);
3684 if (! EQ (tem
, Qnil
)) mod_super
= XUINT (tem
);
3687 return ( ((state
& mod_alt
) ? dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
: 0)
3688 | ((state
& mod_super
) ? dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
: 0)
3689 | ((state
& mod_hyper
) ? dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
: 0)
3690 | ((state
& shift_modifier
) ? ShiftMask
: 0)
3691 | ((state
& ctrl_modifier
) ? ControlMask
: 0)
3692 | ((state
& mod_meta
) ? dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
: 0));
3695 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3698 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym
)
3703 value
= XKeysymToString (keysym
);
3711 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3713 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3715 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3719 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event
*result
, XButtonEvent
*event
, struct frame
*f
)
3721 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3723 result
->kind
= MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT
;
3724 result
->code
= event
->button
- Button1
;
3725 result
->timestamp
= event
->time
;
3726 result
->modifiers
= (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
3728 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
3732 XSETINT (result
->x
, event
->x
);
3733 XSETINT (result
->y
, event
->y
);
3734 XSETFRAME (result
->frame_or_window
, f
);
3740 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3741 The input handler calls this.
3743 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3744 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3745 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3746 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3748 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event
;
3749 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame
;
3752 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame
, XMotionEvent
*event
)
3754 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->time
;
3755 last_mouse_motion_event
= *event
;
3756 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
, frame
);
3758 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame
))
3761 if (event
->window
!= FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame
))
3763 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3764 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3765 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, -1, -1);
3766 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
3771 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3772 if (frame
!= last_mouse_glyph_frame
3773 || event
->x
< last_mouse_glyph
.x
3774 || event
->x
>= last_mouse_glyph
.x
+ last_mouse_glyph
.width
3775 || event
->y
< last_mouse_glyph
.y
3776 || event
->y
>= last_mouse_glyph
.y
+ last_mouse_glyph
.height
)
3778 frame
->mouse_moved
= 1;
3779 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3780 note_mouse_highlight (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
);
3781 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3782 remember_mouse_glyph (frame
, event
->x
, event
->y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
3783 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= frame
;
3791 /************************************************************************
3793 ************************************************************************/
3796 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3798 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame
)
3799 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
)))
3800 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame
),
3801 last_mouse_motion_event
.x
,
3802 last_mouse_motion_event
.y
);
3807 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3808 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3810 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3811 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3812 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3813 position on the scroll bar.
3815 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3816 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3819 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3820 was at this position.
3822 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3824 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3828 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR
*fp
, int insist
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
3829 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
, Lisp_Object
*y
,
3830 long unsigned int *timestamp
)
3836 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar
) && insist
== 0)
3837 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp
, bar_window
, part
, x
, y
, timestamp
);
3843 Window dummy_window
;
3846 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
3848 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3849 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
3850 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
3851 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
))
3852 XFRAME (frame
)->mouse_moved
= 0;
3854 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
3856 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3857 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3858 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)),
3860 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3863 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3864 a different screen. */
3867 /* The position on that root window. */
3870 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3873 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3875 (unsigned int *) &dummy
);
3877 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3878 containing the pointer. */
3882 int parent_x
= 0, parent_y
= 0;
3886 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3887 structure is changing at the same time this function
3888 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3890 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
));
3892 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
)->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
3893 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
3895 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3896 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3897 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3899 /* From-window, to-window. */
3900 root
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame
),
3902 /* From-position, to-position. */
3903 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3907 f1
= last_mouse_frame
;
3913 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
),
3915 /* From-window, to-window. */
3918 /* From-position, to-position. */
3919 root_x
, root_y
, &win_x
, &win_y
,
3924 if (child
== None
|| child
== win
)
3927 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3928 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3929 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3930 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3931 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
))
3939 /* Now we know that:
3940 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3941 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3942 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3943 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3944 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3945 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3946 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3947 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3948 never use them in that case.) */
3951 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3952 want the edit window. */
3953 f1
= x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3955 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3956 f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp
), win
);
3959 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3960 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3963 && f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
3964 && win
== XtWindow (f1
->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
))
3966 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3969 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
)))
3972 x_uncatch_errors ();
3974 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3977 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
3979 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp
), win
);
3983 f1
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
3989 if (f1
== 0 && insist
> 0)
3990 f1
= SELECTED_FRAME ();
3994 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3995 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3996 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3997 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3998 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3999 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4000 the frame are divided into. */
4002 remember_mouse_glyph (f1
, win_x
, win_y
, &last_mouse_glyph
);
4003 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= f1
;
4008 XSETINT (*x
, win_x
);
4009 XSETINT (*y
, win_y
);
4010 *timestamp
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
4020 /***********************************************************************
4022 ***********************************************************************/
4024 /* Scroll bar support. */
4026 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4028 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4031 static struct scroll_bar
*
4032 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display
*display
, Window window_id
)
4036 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4037 window_id
= (Window
) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display
, window_id
);
4038 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4040 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
4042 Lisp_Object frame
, bar
, condemned
;
4044 frame
= XCAR (tail
);
4045 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4046 if (! FRAMEP (frame
))
4049 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
)))
4052 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4054 condemned
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4055 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame
));
4056 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4057 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4058 ! NILP (bar
) || (bar
= condemned
,
4061 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
4062 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
== window_id
&&
4063 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame
)) == display
)
4064 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
4071 #if defined USE_LUCID
4073 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4074 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4077 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window
)
4081 for (tail
= Vframe_list
; CONSP (tail
); tail
= XCDR (tail
))
4083 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail
))))
4085 Lisp_Object frame
= XCAR (tail
);
4086 Widget menu_bar
= XFRAME (frame
)->output_data
.x
->menubar_widget
;
4088 if (menu_bar
&& xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar
, window
))
4096 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4099 /************************************************************************
4101 ************************************************************************/
4103 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4105 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*, struct input_event
*);
4106 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object
, int, int, int);
4107 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*,
4108 struct scroll_bar
*);
4109 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*,
4113 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4114 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4116 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled
;
4118 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4120 static int last_scroll_bar_part
;
4122 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4123 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4126 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4128 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id
;
4130 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll
;
4132 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4133 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4134 to avoid jerkyness. */
4136 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top
;
4138 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4139 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4140 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4141 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4144 xt_action_hook (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, String action_name
,
4145 XEvent
*event
, String
*params
, Cardinal
*num_params
)
4148 const char *end_action
;
4151 scroll_bar_p
= XmIsScrollBar (widget
);
4152 end_action
= "Release";
4153 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4154 scroll_bar_p
= XtIsSubclass (widget
, scrollbarWidgetClass
);
4155 end_action
= "EndScroll";
4156 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4159 && strcmp (action_name
, end_action
) == 0
4160 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4164 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4165 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4166 w
= XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled
);
4168 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
))
4170 XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
)->dragging
= Qnil
;
4171 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4172 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w
);
4174 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4175 last_scroll_bar_part
= -1;
4177 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4178 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 0;
4181 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4183 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4184 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4186 static struct window
**scroll_bar_windows
;
4187 static size_t scroll_bar_windows_size
;
4190 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4191 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4192 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4193 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4196 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window
, int part
, int portion
, int whole
)
4199 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) &event
;
4200 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (window
);
4201 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4206 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4207 ev
->type
= ClientMessage
;
4208 ev
->message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_Scrollbar
;
4209 ev
->display
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
4210 ev
->window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
4213 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4214 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4215 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4216 into that array in the event. */
4217 for (i
= 0; i
< scroll_bar_windows_size
; ++i
)
4218 if (scroll_bar_windows
[i
] == NULL
)
4221 if (i
== scroll_bar_windows_size
)
4223 size_t new_size
= max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size
);
4224 size_t nbytes
= new_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4225 size_t old_nbytes
= scroll_bar_windows_size
* sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
;
4227 if ((size_t) -1 / sizeof *scroll_bar_windows
< new_size
)
4229 scroll_bar_windows
= (struct window
**) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows
,
4231 memset (&scroll_bar_windows
[i
], 0, nbytes
- old_nbytes
);
4232 scroll_bar_windows_size
= new_size
;
4235 scroll_bar_windows
[i
] = w
;
4236 ev
->data
.l
[0] = (long) i
;
4237 ev
->data
.l
[1] = (long) part
;
4238 ev
->data
.l
[2] = (long) 0;
4239 ev
->data
.l
[3] = (long) portion
;
4240 ev
->data
.l
[4] = (long) whole
;
4242 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4243 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4244 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
= 1;
4245 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4248 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4249 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4250 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4251 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), False
, 0, &event
);
4256 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4260 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*ievent
)
4262 XClientMessageEvent
*ev
= (XClientMessageEvent
*) event
;
4266 w
= scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]];
4267 scroll_bar_windows
[ev
->data
.l
[0]] = NULL
;
4269 XSETWINDOW (window
, w
);
4271 ievent
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
4272 ievent
->frame_or_window
= window
;
4275 ievent
->timestamp
= CurrentTime
;
4278 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w
->frame
)));
4280 ievent
->part
= ev
->data
.l
[1];
4281 ievent
->code
= ev
->data
.l
[2];
4282 ievent
->x
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[3]);
4283 ievent
->y
= make_number ((int) ev
->data
.l
[4]);
4284 ievent
->modifiers
= 0;
4290 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4292 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4295 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4296 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4297 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4300 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4302 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4303 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*cs
= (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct
*) call_data
;
4304 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4308 case XmCR_DECREMENT
:
4309 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4310 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4313 case XmCR_INCREMENT
:
4314 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4315 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4318 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT
:
4319 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4320 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4323 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT
:
4324 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4325 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4329 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4330 part
= scroll_bar_to_top
;
4333 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM
:
4334 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4335 part
= scroll_bar_to_bottom
;
4342 /* Get the slider size. */
4344 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XmNsliderSize
, &slider_size
, NULL
);
4347 whole
= XM_SB_MAX
- slider_size
;
4348 portion
= min (cs
->value
, whole
);
4349 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4350 bar
->dragging
= make_number (cs
->value
);
4354 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED
:
4360 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4361 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4362 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4366 #elif defined USE_GTK
4368 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4369 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4372 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange
*range
,
4373 GtkScrollType scroll
,
4377 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) user_data
;
4379 int part
= -1, whole
= 0, portion
= 0;
4380 GtkAdjustment
*adj
= GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range
));
4381 FRAME_PTR f
= (FRAME_PTR
) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range
), XG_FRAME_DATA
);
4383 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar
) return FALSE
;
4384 position
= gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj
);
4389 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP
:
4390 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4391 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
!= 0
4392 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->grabbed
< (1 << 4))
4394 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4395 whole
= gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj
) -
4396 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj
);
4397 portion
= min ((int)position
, whole
);
4398 bar
->dragging
= make_number ((int)portion
);
4401 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD
:
4402 part
= scroll_bar_up_arrow
;
4403 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4405 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD
:
4406 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4407 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4409 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD
:
4410 part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
4411 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4413 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD
:
4414 part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4415 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4421 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4422 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4423 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4429 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4432 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget
*widget
,
4433 GdkEventButton
*event
,
4436 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) user_data
;
4437 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4438 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled
))
4440 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled
,
4441 scroll_bar_end_scroll
, 0, 0);
4442 window_being_scrolled
= Qnil
;
4449 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4451 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4452 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4453 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4457 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4459 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4460 float top
= *(float *) call_data
;
4462 int whole
, portion
, height
;
4465 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4467 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNshown
, &shown
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4471 portion
= shown
< 1 ? top
* whole
: 0;
4473 if (shown
< 1 && (eabs (top
+ shown
- 1) < 1.0/height
))
4474 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4475 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4476 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4477 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4479 part
= scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4481 part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
4483 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4484 bar
->dragging
= make_number (portion
);
4485 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4486 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, portion
, whole
);
4490 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4491 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4492 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4493 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4494 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4495 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4496 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4499 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget
, XtPointer client_data
, XtPointer call_data
)
4501 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= (struct scroll_bar
*) client_data
;
4502 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4503 int position
= (long) call_data
;
4507 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4509 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
4512 if (eabs (position
) >= height
)
4513 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle
: scroll_bar_below_handle
;
4515 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4516 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4517 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
&& eabs (position
) <= max (5, height
/ 20))
4518 part
= (position
< 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow
: scroll_bar_down_arrow
;
4520 part
= scroll_bar_move_ratio
;
4522 window_being_scrolled
= bar
->window
;
4523 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4524 last_scroll_bar_part
= part
;
4525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar
->window
, part
, position
, height
);
4528 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4530 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4532 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4533 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4537 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4539 const char *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4542 xg_create_scroll_bar (f
, bar
, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback
),
4543 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback
),
4548 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4551 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame
*f
, struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
4557 char const *scroll_bar_name
= SCROLL_BAR_NAME
;
4558 unsigned long pixel
;
4563 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4564 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4565 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNminimum
, 0); ++ac
;
4566 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNmaximum
, XM_SB_MAX
); ++ac
;
4567 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNorientation
, XmVERTICAL
); ++ac
;
4568 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNprocessingDirection
, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM
), ++ac
;
4569 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNincrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4570 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNpageIncrement
, 1); ++ac
;
4572 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4575 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNforeground
, pixel
);
4579 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4582 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XmNbackground
, pixel
);
4586 widget
= XmCreateScrollBar (f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
,
4587 scroll_bar_name
, av
, ac
);
4589 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4590 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4592 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNdragCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4594 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNincrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4596 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageDecrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4598 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNpageIncrementCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4600 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoBottomCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4602 XtAddCallback (widget
, XmNtoTopCallback
, xm_scroll_callback
,
4605 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4606 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4608 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4609 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4610 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget
), XtWindow (widget
),
4611 f
->output_data
.x
->nontext_cursor
);
4613 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4615 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4616 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4617 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4618 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4619 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNmappedWhenManaged
, False
); ++ac
;
4620 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNorientation
, XtorientVertical
); ++ac
;
4621 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4622 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4624 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
;
4627 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNforeground
, pixel
);
4631 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4634 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbackground
, pixel
);
4638 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4640 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4641 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4643 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4646 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4647 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4648 &pixel
, 1.2, 0x8000))
4650 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4653 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4655 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4658 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
4659 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f
),
4660 &pixel
, 0.6, 0x4000))
4662 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
= pixel
;
4666 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4667 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4668 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
== -1
4669 || f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
== -1)
4670 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4671 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4672 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4675 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
,
4676 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f
)) < 16);
4680 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4681 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4682 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4684 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4686 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbeNiceToColormap
, False
);
4689 /* Specify the colors. */
4690 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
;
4693 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNtopShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4696 pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
;
4699 XtSetArg (av
[ac
], XtNbottomShadowPixel
, pixel
);
4705 widget
= XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name
, scrollbarWidgetClass
,
4706 f
->output_data
.x
->edit_widget
, av
, ac
);
4709 char const *initial
= "";
4710 char const *val
= initial
;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget
, XtNscrollVCursor
, (XtPointer
) &val
,
4712 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4713 XtNarrowScrollbars
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll
,
4715 XtNpickTop
, (XtPointer
) &xaw3d_pick_top
, NULL
);
4716 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll
|| val
== initial
)
4717 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4718 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= True
;
4719 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4720 XtVaSetValues (widget
, XtNcursorName
, "top_left_arrow", NULL
);
4724 /* Define callbacks. */
4725 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNjumpProc
, xaw_jump_callback
, (XtPointer
) bar
);
4726 XtAddCallback (widget
, XtNscrollProc
, xaw_scroll_callback
,
4729 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4730 XtRealizeWidget (widget
);
4732 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4734 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4735 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4736 if (action_hook_id
== 0)
4737 action_hook_id
= XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con
, xt_action_hook
, 0);
4739 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4740 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar
, widget
);
4741 xwindow
= XtWindow (widget
);
4742 bar
->x_window
= xwindow
;
4746 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4749 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4750 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4754 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
, int whole
)
4756 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
4759 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4761 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int portion
, int position
,
4764 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4765 Widget widget
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4772 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4773 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4774 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4775 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4776 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4777 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4778 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4779 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4780 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4781 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4782 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4783 portion
= WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)) * 30;
4784 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4785 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4792 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4793 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4796 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4800 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4801 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4803 size
= shown
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4804 size
= min (size
, XM_SB_MAX
);
4805 size
= max (size
, 1);
4807 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4808 value
= top
* XM_SB_MAX
;
4809 value
= min (value
, XM_SB_MAX
- size
);
4811 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget
, value
, size
, 0, 0, False
);
4813 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4819 top
= (float) position
/ whole
;
4820 shown
= (float) portion
/ whole
;
4824 float old_top
, old_shown
;
4826 XtVaGetValues (widget
,
4827 XtNtopOfThumb
, &old_top
,
4828 XtNshown
, &old_shown
,
4832 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4833 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
) || last_scroll_bar_part
== scroll_bar_down_arrow
)
4834 top
= max (0, min (1, top
));
4837 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4838 shown
= max (0, min (1 - top
- (2.0 / height
), shown
));
4840 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4841 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4842 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4843 if (top
!= old_top
|| shown
!= old_shown
)
4845 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
4846 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4849 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4850 if (!xaw3d_pick_top
)
4851 shown
= min (shown
, old_shown
);
4853 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget
, top
, shown
);
4857 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4861 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4863 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4867 /************************************************************************
4868 Scroll bars, general
4869 ************************************************************************/
4871 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4872 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4873 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4876 static struct scroll_bar
*
4877 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window
*w
, int top
, int left
, int width
, int height
)
4879 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
4880 struct scroll_bar
*bar
4881 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar
, x_window
, PVEC_OTHER
);
4885 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4886 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f
, bar
);
4887 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4889 XSetWindowAttributes a
;
4893 a
.background_pixel
= f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
;
4894 if (a
.background_pixel
== -1)
4895 a
.background_pixel
= FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
);
4897 a
.event_mask
= (ButtonPressMask
| ButtonReleaseMask
4898 | ButtonMotionMask
| PointerMotionHintMask
4900 a
.cursor
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
;
4902 mask
= (CWBackPixel
| CWEventMask
| CWCursor
);
4904 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4905 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4906 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4907 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
4908 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4910 window_box_height (w
), False
);
4912 window
= XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
4913 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4914 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4916 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4918 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4925 bar
->x_window
= window
;
4927 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4929 XSETWINDOW (bar
->window
, w
);
4933 bar
->height
= height
;
4936 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
4937 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= 0;
4939 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4940 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
4942 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
4943 if (!NILP (bar
->next
))
4944 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
4946 /* Map the window/widget. */
4947 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4950 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
4953 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4954 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4956 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4957 Widget scroll_bar
= SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
);
4958 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar
,
4959 left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
4961 width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
4962 max (height
, 1), 0);
4963 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar
);
4964 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4966 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4967 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
4968 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4975 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4977 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4979 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4980 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4981 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4984 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4985 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4986 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4987 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4988 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4991 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, int start
, int end
, int rebuild
)
4993 int dragging
= ! NILP (bar
->dragging
);
4994 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
4995 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
4996 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
4998 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5000 && start
== bar
->start
5007 int inside_width
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f
, bar
->width
);
5008 int inside_height
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f
, bar
->height
);
5009 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5011 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5012 the distance between start and end. */
5014 int length
= end
- start
;
5018 else if (start
> top_range
)
5020 end
= start
+ length
;
5024 else if (end
> top_range
&& ! dragging
)
5028 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5032 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5033 if (end
> top_range
)
5036 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5037 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5038 that many pixels tall. */
5039 end
+= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
;
5041 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5042 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5044 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5045 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5046 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5047 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
,
5048 inside_width
, start
,
5051 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5052 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5053 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5054 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5056 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5057 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5058 /* x, y, width, height */
5059 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5060 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ start
,
5061 inside_width
, end
- start
);
5063 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5064 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5065 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5066 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5068 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5069 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5070 if (end
< inside_height
)
5071 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5072 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5073 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER
,
5074 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
+ end
,
5075 inside_width
, inside_height
- end
,
5083 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5085 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5089 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar
*bar
)
5091 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5094 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5096 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f
, bar
->x_window
);
5097 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5098 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
));
5099 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5101 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
);
5104 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5105 XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->vertical_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5111 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5112 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5113 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5117 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window
*w
, int portion
, int whole
, int position
)
5119 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
5120 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5121 int top
, height
, left
, sb_left
, width
, sb_width
;
5122 int window_y
, window_height
;
5123 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5124 int fringe_extended_p
;
5127 /* Get window dimensions. */
5128 window_box (w
, -1, 0, &window_y
, 0, &window_height
);
5130 width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5131 height
= window_height
;
5133 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5134 left
= WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w
);
5136 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5137 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5138 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
) > 0)
5139 sb_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w
);
5143 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5144 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5145 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5146 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
) ? width
- sb_width
: 0);
5148 sb_left
= left
+ (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
) ? 0 : width
- sb_width
);
5150 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w
))
5151 sb_left
= left
+ width
- sb_width
;
5156 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5157 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5158 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w
)
5159 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5160 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5161 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5163 fringe_extended_p
= (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w
)
5164 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w
)
5165 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w
)
5166 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w
) == 0));
5169 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5170 if (NILP (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5172 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5175 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5176 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5177 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5178 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5181 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5182 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5186 bar
= x_scroll_bar_create (w
, top
, sb_left
, sb_width
, height
);
5190 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5191 unsigned int mask
= 0;
5193 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5197 if (sb_left
!= bar
->left
)
5199 if (top
!= bar
->top
)
5201 if (sb_width
!= bar
->width
)
5203 if (height
!= bar
->height
)
5206 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5208 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5209 if (mask
|| bar
->fringe_extended_p
!= fringe_extended_p
)
5211 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5212 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5213 if (width
> 0 && height
> 0)
5215 if (fringe_extended_p
)
5216 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5217 sb_left
, top
, sb_width
, height
, False
);
5219 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5220 left
, top
, width
, height
, False
);
5223 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f
,
5226 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5227 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
*2,
5229 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5230 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
),
5231 sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5233 sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2,
5234 max (height
, 1), 0);
5235 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5237 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5239 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5240 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5241 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
)
5243 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5244 left
, top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5246 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5247 left
+ width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5248 top
, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
,
5252 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5253 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5254 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5257 int area_width
= WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
5258 int rest
= area_width
- sb_width
;
5259 if (rest
> 0 && height
> 0)
5261 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w
))
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5263 left
+ area_width
- rest
, top
,
5264 rest
, height
, False
);
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
5267 left
, top
, rest
, height
, False
);
5271 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5276 wc
.x
= sb_left
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5278 wc
.width
= sb_width
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
* 2;
5280 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), bar
->x_window
,
5284 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5286 /* Remember new settings. */
5287 bar
->left
= sb_left
;
5289 bar
->width
= sb_width
;
5290 bar
->height
= height
;
5295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5296 bar
->fringe_extended_p
= fringe_extended_p
;
5298 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar
, portion
, position
, whole
);
5299 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5300 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5302 if (NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5304 int top_range
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, height
);
5307 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, 0, top_range
, 0);
5310 int start
= ((double) position
* top_range
) / whole
;
5311 int end
= ((double) (position
+ portion
) * top_range
) / whole
;
5312 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, start
, end
, 0);
5315 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5317 XSETVECTOR (w
->vertical_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5321 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5322 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5323 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5324 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5325 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5326 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5327 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5329 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5330 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5331 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5334 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame
)
5336 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5337 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5340 bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5341 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
;
5342 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
);
5343 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->prev
= Qnil
;
5344 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
)))
5345 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
))->prev
= bar
;
5346 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame
) = bar
;
5351 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5352 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5355 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window
*window
)
5357 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
5360 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5361 if (NILP (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5364 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (window
->vertical_scroll_bar
);
5366 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5367 f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window
));
5368 if (NILP (bar
->prev
))
5370 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5372 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5373 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5375 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
),
5376 window
->vertical_scroll_bar
))
5377 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = bar
->next
;
5379 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5380 one or the other! */
5384 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->prev
)->next
= bar
->next
;
5386 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5387 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
= bar
->prev
;
5389 bar
->next
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5391 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
), bar
);
5392 if (! NILP (bar
->next
))
5393 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar
->next
)->prev
, bar
);
5396 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5397 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5400 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f
)
5402 Lisp_Object bar
, next
;
5404 bar
= FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
);
5406 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5407 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5408 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f
) = Qnil
;
5410 for (; ! NILP (bar
); bar
= next
)
5412 struct scroll_bar
*b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
5414 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
5417 b
->next
= b
->prev
= Qnil
;
5420 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5421 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5425 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5426 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5427 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5429 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5433 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
)
5435 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5436 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5437 GC gc
= f
->output_data
.x
->normal_gc
;
5438 int width_trim
= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM
;
5442 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, bar
->start
, bar
->end
, 1);
5444 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5445 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5446 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5447 f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
5449 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5450 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
, gc
,
5452 /* x, y, width, height */
5454 bar
->width
- 1 - width_trim
- width_trim
,
5457 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5458 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
5459 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
,
5460 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
5465 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5467 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5468 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5470 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5475 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
, struct input_event
*emacs_event
)
5477 if (! WINDOWP (bar
->window
))
5480 emacs_event
->kind
= SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
;
5481 emacs_event
->code
= event
->xbutton
.button
- Button1
;
5482 emacs_event
->modifiers
5483 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5484 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)))),
5485 event
->xbutton
.state
)
5486 | (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5489 emacs_event
->frame_or_window
= bar
->window
;
5490 emacs_event
->arg
= Qnil
;
5491 emacs_event
->timestamp
= event
->xbutton
.time
;
5494 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5495 int y
= event
->xbutton
.y
- VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5498 if (y
> top_range
) y
= top_range
;
5501 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5502 else if (y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5503 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5505 emacs_event
->part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5507 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5508 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5509 if (event
->type
== ButtonRelease
5510 && ! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5512 int new_start
= y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5513 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5515 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5516 bar
->dragging
= Qnil
;
5520 XSETINT (emacs_event
->x
, y
);
5521 XSETINT (emacs_event
->y
, top_range
);
5525 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5527 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5529 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5533 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar
*bar
, XEvent
*event
)
5535 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)->frame
);
5537 last_mouse_movement_time
= event
->xmotion
.time
;
5540 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
, bar
);
5542 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5543 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5545 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5546 int new_start
= event
->xmotion
.y
- XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5548 if (new_start
!= bar
->start
)
5550 int new_end
= new_start
+ bar
->end
- bar
->start
;
5552 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar
, new_start
, new_end
, 0);
5557 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5559 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5560 on the scroll bar. */
5563 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR
*fp
, Lisp_Object
*bar_window
,
5564 enum scroll_bar_part
*part
, Lisp_Object
*x
,
5565 Lisp_Object
*y
, long unsigned int *timestamp
)
5567 struct scroll_bar
*bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
5568 Window w
= bar
->x_window
;
5569 FRAME_PTR f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar
->window
)));
5571 Window dummy_window
;
5573 unsigned int dummy_mask
;
5577 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5579 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), w
,
5581 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5582 &dummy_window
, &dummy_window
,
5583 &dummy_coord
, &dummy_coord
,
5585 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5588 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5594 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f
, bar
->height
);
5596 win_y
-= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER
;
5598 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5599 win_y
-= XINT (bar
->dragging
);
5603 if (win_y
> top_range
)
5607 *bar_window
= bar
->window
;
5609 if (! NILP (bar
->dragging
))
5610 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5611 else if (win_y
< bar
->start
)
5612 *part
= scroll_bar_above_handle
;
5613 else if (win_y
< bar
->end
+ VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE
)
5614 *part
= scroll_bar_handle
;
5616 *part
= scroll_bar_below_handle
;
5618 XSETINT (*x
, win_y
);
5619 XSETINT (*y
, top_range
);
5622 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
5625 *timestamp
= last_mouse_movement_time
;
5631 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5632 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5633 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5637 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f
)
5639 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5642 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5643 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5644 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5645 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
))
5646 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); VECTORP (bar
);
5647 bar
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->next
)
5648 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5649 XSCROLL_BAR (bar
)->x_window
,
5651 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5655 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5657 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5658 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5659 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5660 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5662 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5663 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5665 static XComposeStatus compose_status
;
5667 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5668 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5670 static int temp_index
;
5671 static short temp_buffer
[100];
5673 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5674 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5676 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5678 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5679 on a particular display. */
5681 static struct x_display_info
*XTread_socket_fake_io_error
;
5683 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5684 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5685 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5686 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5688 static struct x_display_info
*next_noop_dpyinfo
;
5690 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5691 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5694 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5695 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5696 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5697 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5698 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5699 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5711 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5712 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5713 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5715 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5717 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5721 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*event
)
5723 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5724 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5725 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5728 struct frame
*f1
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5729 event
->xclient
.window
);
5731 return XFilterEvent (event
, f1
? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1
) : None
);
5736 static int current_count
;
5737 static int current_finish
;
5738 static struct input_event
*current_hold_quit
;
5740 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5741 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5742 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5743 static GdkFilterReturn
5744 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent
*gxev
, GdkEvent
*ev
, gpointer data
)
5746 XEvent
*xev
= (XEvent
*) gxev
;
5749 if (current_count
>= 0)
5751 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
5753 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (xev
->xany
.display
);
5756 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5757 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5758 so we do it here. */
5759 if ((xev
->type
== KeyPress
|| xev
->type
== KeyRelease
)
5761 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo
, xev
))
5764 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5769 current_finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5772 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, xev
, ¤t_finish
,
5776 current_finish
= x_dispatch_event (xev
, xev
->xany
.display
);
5780 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
|| current_finish
== X_EVENT_DROP
)
5781 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE
;
5783 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE
;
5785 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5788 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time
,
5789 enum xembed_message
,
5790 long detail
, long data1
, long data2
);
5792 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5794 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5795 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5796 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5798 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5801 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, XEvent
*eventptr
,
5802 int *finish
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
5805 struct input_event ie
;
5806 struct selection_input_event sie
;
5811 struct frame
*f
= NULL
;
5812 struct coding_system coding
;
5813 XEvent event
= *eventptr
;
5814 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
5816 *finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
5818 EVENT_INIT (inev
.ie
);
5819 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
;
5822 if (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
== event
.type
)
5823 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5829 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5830 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
5831 && event
.xclient
.format
== 32)
5833 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5834 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
)
5836 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5837 could be the shell widget window
5838 if the frame has no title bar. */
5839 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5841 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5842 if (f
&& FRAME_XIC (f
))
5843 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f
));
5845 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5846 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5847 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5848 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5849 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5852 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5853 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5854 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5855 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5858 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5859 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5860 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5863 Display
*d
= event
.xclient
.display
;
5864 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5865 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5867 XSetInputFocus (d
, event
.xclient
.window
,
5868 /* The ICCCM says this is
5869 the only valid choice. */
5871 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1]);
5872 /* This is needed to detect the error
5873 if there is an error. */
5875 x_uncatch_errors ();
5877 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5882 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5883 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
)
5885 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5886 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5887 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5888 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5889 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5890 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5891 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5892 session manager and one for this. */
5894 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5897 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5898 event
.xclient
.window
);
5899 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5900 for a single Emacs process. */
5901 if (f
== SELECTED_FRAME ())
5902 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5903 event
.xclient
.window
,
5904 initial_argv
, initial_argc
);
5906 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
5907 event
.xclient
.window
,
5913 if (event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0]
5914 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
)
5916 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
,
5917 event
.xclient
.window
);
5919 goto OTHER
; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5921 inev
.ie
.kind
= DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT
;
5922 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
5929 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
)
5935 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5936 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
)
5939 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5941 new_x
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[0];
5942 new_y
= event
.xclient
.data
.s
[1];
5946 f
->left_pos
= new_x
;
5953 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5954 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
)
5956 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5958 _XEditResCheckMessages (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, NULL
,
5962 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5964 if ((event
.xclient
.message_type
5965 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
)
5966 || (event
.xclient
.message_type
5967 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
))
5969 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5970 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5971 currently never do because we are interested in
5972 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5973 Pixmap pixmap
= (Pixmap
) event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5974 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
5977 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap
, f
);
5978 expose_frame (f
, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5982 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5983 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5984 we construct an input_event. */
5985 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5986 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
)
5988 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event
, &inev
.ie
);
5989 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
5992 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5994 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5995 if (event
.xclient
.message_type
5996 == dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
)
5998 enum xembed_message msg
= event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1];
5999 if (msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_IN
|| msg
== XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT
)
6000 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6002 *finish
= X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
;
6006 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6008 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xclient
.window
);
6011 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f
, &event
.xclient
, dpyinfo
, &inev
.ie
))
6012 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6016 case SelectionNotify
:
6017 last_user_time
= event
.xselection
.time
;
6018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselection
.requestor
))
6021 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6022 x_handle_selection_notify (&event
.xselection
);
6025 case SelectionClear
: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6026 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionclear
.time
;
6027 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6028 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionclear
.window
))
6030 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6032 XSelectionClearEvent
*eventp
= &(event
.xselectionclear
);
6034 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT
;
6035 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6036 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6037 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6038 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
6042 case SelectionRequest
: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6043 last_user_time
= event
.xselectionrequest
.time
;
6044 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6045 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xselectionrequest
.owner
))
6047 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6049 XSelectionRequestEvent
*eventp
= &(event
.xselectionrequest
);
6051 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT
;
6052 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->display
;
6053 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->requestor
;
6054 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->selection
;
6055 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->target
;
6056 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->property
;
6057 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev
.sie
) = eventp
->time
;
6058 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= Qnil
;
6062 case PropertyNotify
:
6063 last_user_time
= event
.xproperty
.time
;
6064 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xproperty
.window
);
6065 if (f
&& event
.xproperty
.atom
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
)
6066 x_handle_net_wm_state (f
, &event
.xproperty
);
6068 x_handle_property_notify (&event
.xproperty
);
6069 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6072 case ReparentNotify
:
6073 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xreparent
.window
);
6077 f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
= event
.xreparent
.parent
;
6078 x_real_positions (f
, &x
, &y
);
6082 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6083 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
6084 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->net_supported_window
= 0;
6089 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xexpose
.window
);
6093 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6094 x_clear_area (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6095 event
.xexpose
.window
,
6096 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6097 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
,
6100 if (f
->async_visible
== 0)
6102 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6103 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6104 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6105 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6109 event
.xexpose
.x
, event
.xexpose
.y
,
6110 event
.xexpose
.width
, event
.xexpose
.height
);
6114 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6115 struct scroll_bar
*bar
;
6117 #if defined USE_LUCID
6118 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6119 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6120 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6123 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event
.xexpose
.window
);
6125 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget
);
6127 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6129 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6130 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6132 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6133 bar
= x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xexpose
.display
,
6134 event
.xexpose
.window
);
6137 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar
, &event
);
6138 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6141 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6142 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6146 case GraphicsExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6147 source area was obscured or not
6149 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.drawable
);
6153 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.x
, event
.xgraphicsexpose
.y
,
6154 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.width
,
6155 event
.xgraphicsexpose
.height
);
6157 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6160 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6163 case NoExpose
: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6164 source area was completely
6169 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6170 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6173 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6176 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xunmap
.window
);
6177 if (f
) /* F may no longer exist if
6178 the frame was deleted. */
6180 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6181 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6182 display that won't ever be seen. */
6183 f
->async_visible
= 0;
6184 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6185 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6186 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6187 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6188 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6189 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6190 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
))
6192 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
6194 inev
.ie
.kind
= ICONIFY_EVENT
;
6195 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6201 if (event
.xmap
.window
== tip_window
)
6202 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6203 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6206 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6207 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6208 frame is visible. */
6209 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmap
.window
);
6212 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6213 the frame's display structures.
6214 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6215 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6216 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6217 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6218 if (! f
->async_iconified
)
6219 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6221 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6222 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6223 if (!f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
)
6224 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
6226 f
->async_visible
= 1;
6227 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
6228 f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
= 1;
6232 inev
.ie
.kind
= DEICONIFY_EVENT
;
6233 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6235 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list
)
6236 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list
)))
6237 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6238 to update the frame titles
6239 in case this is the second frame. */
6240 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6243 xg_frame_resized (f
, -1, -1);
6250 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6251 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6253 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6254 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6255 if (popup_activated ())
6259 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xkey
.window
);
6261 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6262 mouse highlighting. */
6263 if (!hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
&& INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight
)
6265 || !EQ (f
->tool_bar_window
, hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
)))
6267 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6268 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 1;
6271 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6274 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6275 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6276 Widget widget
= XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo
->display
,
6278 if (widget
&& XmIsScrollBar (widget
))
6280 widget
= XtParent (widget
);
6281 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, XtWindow (widget
));
6284 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6288 KeySym keysym
, orig_keysym
;
6289 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6290 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6293 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6294 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6295 status_return even if the input is too long to
6296 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6297 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6298 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6299 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6300 unsigned char copy_buffer
[513];
6301 unsigned char *copy_bufptr
= copy_buffer
;
6302 int copy_bufsiz
= sizeof (copy_buffer
);
6304 Lisp_Object coding_system
= Qlatin_1
;
6308 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6309 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6310 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6312 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6316 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
),
6317 extra_keyboard_modifiers
);
6318 modifiers
= event
.xkey
.state
;
6320 /* This will have to go some day... */
6322 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6323 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6324 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~ControlMask
;
6325 event
.xkey
.state
&= ~(dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
6326 | dpyinfo
->super_mod_mask
6327 | dpyinfo
->hyper_mod_mask
6328 | dpyinfo
->alt_mod_mask
);
6330 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6331 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6332 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6333 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6334 not it is combined with Meta. */
6335 if (modifiers
& dpyinfo
->meta_mod_mask
)
6336 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6341 Status status_return
;
6343 coding_system
= Vlocale_coding_system
;
6344 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6345 &event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6346 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6348 if (status_return
== XBufferOverflow
)
6350 copy_bufsiz
= nbytes
+ 1;
6351 copy_bufptr
= (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz
);
6352 nbytes
= XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f
),
6353 &event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6354 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6357 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6358 if (status_return
== XLookupNone
)
6360 else if (status_return
== XLookupChars
)
6365 else if (status_return
!= XLookupKeySym
6366 && status_return
!= XLookupBoth
)
6370 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6371 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6374 nbytes
= XLookupString (&event
.xkey
, (char *) copy_bufptr
,
6375 copy_bufsiz
, &keysym
,
6379 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6380 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6381 if (compose_status
.chars_matched
> 0 && nbytes
== 0)
6384 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6385 orig_keysym
= keysym
;
6387 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6388 XSETFRAME (inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
, f
);
6390 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
), modifiers
);
6391 inev
.ie
.timestamp
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6393 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6394 translations to characters. */
6395 if (keysym
>= 32 && keysym
< 128)
6396 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6398 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6399 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6403 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6404 if (keysym
>= 0x01000000 && keysym
<= 0x0110FFFF)
6406 if (keysym
< 0x01000080)
6407 inev
.ie
.kind
= ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6409 inev
.ie
.kind
= MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6410 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
& 0xFFFFFF;
6414 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6415 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table
)
6416 && (NATNUMP (c
= Fgethash (make_number (keysym
),
6420 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c
))
6421 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6422 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6423 inev
.ie
.code
= XFASTINT (c
);
6427 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6428 if (((keysym
>= XK_BackSpace
&& keysym
<= XK_Escape
)
6429 || keysym
== XK_Delete
6430 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6431 || (keysym
>= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6432 && keysym
<= XK_ISO_Enter
)
6434 || IsCursorKey (keysym
) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6435 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6437 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6438 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6439 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6440 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6441 || ((unsigned) (keysym
) >= XK_Select
6442 && (unsigned)(keysym
) < XK_KP_Space
)
6444 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6445 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_circumflex
6447 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6448 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_grave
6450 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6451 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_tilde
6453 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6454 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_diaeresis
6456 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6457 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_macron
6459 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6460 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_degree
6462 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6463 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_acute
6465 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6466 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_cedilla
6468 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6469 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_breve
6471 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6472 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_ogonek
6474 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6475 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_caron
6477 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6478 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_doubleacute
6480 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6481 || orig_keysym
== XK_dead_abovedot
6483 || IsKeypadKey (keysym
) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6484 || IsFunctionKey (keysym
) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6485 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6486 || (orig_keysym
& (1 << 28))
6487 || (keysym
!= NoSymbol
&& nbytes
== 0))
6488 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym
)
6489 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6490 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6491 don't have real modifiers but
6492 should be treated similarly to
6493 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6494 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6495 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6497 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym
)
6498 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
)
6502 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym
);
6503 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6505 inev
.ie
.kind
= NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
;
6506 inev
.ie
.code
= keysym
;
6510 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6514 for (i
= 0, nchars
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
++)
6516 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr
[i
]))
6518 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr
[i
]);
6521 if (nchars
< nbytes
)
6523 /* Decode the input data. */
6526 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6527 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6528 we used just above and the locale. */
6529 setup_coding_system (coding_system
, &coding
);
6530 coding
.src_multibyte
= 0;
6531 coding
.dst_multibyte
= 1;
6532 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6533 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6534 gives us composition information. */
6535 coding
.common_flags
&= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK
;
6537 require
= MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH
* nbytes
;
6538 coding
.destination
= alloca (require
);
6539 coding
.dst_bytes
= require
;
6540 coding
.mode
|= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK
;
6541 decode_coding_c_string (&coding
, copy_bufptr
, nbytes
, Qnil
);
6542 nbytes
= coding
.produced
;
6543 nchars
= coding
.produced_char
;
6544 copy_bufptr
= coding
.destination
;
6547 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6548 character events. */
6549 for (i
= 0; i
< nbytes
; i
+= len
)
6552 if (nchars
== nbytes
)
6553 ch
= copy_bufptr
[i
], len
= 1;
6555 ch
= STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr
+ i
, len
);
6556 inev
.ie
.kind
= (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch
)
6557 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6558 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
);
6560 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6565 inev
.ie
.kind
= NO_EVENT
; /* Already stored above. */
6567 if (keysym
== NoSymbol
)
6573 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6574 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6582 last_user_time
= event
.xkey
.time
;
6584 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6585 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6593 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6594 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6596 f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6598 if (f
&& x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
)
6599 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= event
.xmotion
.time
+ 200;
6601 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6602 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6603 if (f
&& !f
->output_data
.x
->hourglass_p
)
6604 note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
);
6606 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6607 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6608 if (!f
&& last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6609 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6614 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6618 last_user_time
= event
.xcrossing
.time
;
6619 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6621 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xcrossing
.window
);
6624 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
6626 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6627 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6628 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6629 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
6632 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6633 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6634 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6635 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6636 if (any_help_event_p
)
6640 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6641 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame
)
6642 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame
, &event
.xmotion
);
6647 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6652 last_user_time
= event
.xmotion
.time
;
6653 previous_help_echo_string
= help_echo_string
;
6654 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6656 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
&& last_mouse_frame
6657 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6658 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6660 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xmotion
.window
);
6662 if (hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
)
6664 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
6665 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6669 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6675 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6676 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6677 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window
) && !popup_activated ())
6681 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
,
6682 event
.xmotion
.x
, event
.xmotion
.y
,
6685 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6686 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6687 will be selected only when it is active. */
6688 if (WINDOWP (window
)
6689 && !EQ (window
, last_window
)
6690 && !EQ (window
, selected_window
)
6691 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6692 create event iff we don't leave the
6694 && (focus_follows_mouse
6695 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window
)->frame
,
6696 XWINDOW (selected_window
)->frame
))))
6698 inev
.ie
.kind
= SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT
;
6699 inev
.ie
.frame_or_window
= window
;
6704 if (!note_mouse_movement (f
, &event
.xmotion
))
6705 help_echo_string
= previous_help_echo_string
;
6709 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6710 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6711 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xmotion
.display
,
6712 event
.xmotion
.window
);
6715 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar
, &event
);
6716 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6718 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6719 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6720 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo
);
6723 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6724 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6725 if (!NILP (help_echo_string
)
6726 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string
))
6731 case ConfigureNotify
:
6732 f
= x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
);
6735 && (f
= x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xconfigure
.window
))
6736 && event
.xconfigure
.window
== FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
6738 xg_frame_resized (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
,
6739 event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6745 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6747 int rows
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, event
.xconfigure
.height
);
6748 int columns
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, event
.xconfigure
.width
);
6750 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6751 is called by the code that handles resizing
6752 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6754 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6755 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6756 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6757 if (columns
!= FRAME_COLS (f
)
6758 || rows
!= FRAME_LINES (f
)
6759 || event
.xconfigure
.width
!= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6760 || event
.xconfigure
.height
!= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
))
6762 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, columns
, 0, 1, 0);
6763 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
6764 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
6767 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.width
;
6768 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = event
.xconfigure
.height
;
6769 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6773 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6774 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6775 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)
6776 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)))
6779 x_real_positions (f
, &f
->left_pos
, &f
->top_pos
);
6783 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
))
6784 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
6793 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6794 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6797 memset (&compose_status
, 0, sizeof (compose_status
));
6798 last_mouse_glyph_frame
= 0;
6799 last_user_time
= event
.xbutton
.time
;
6801 if (dpyinfo
->grabbed
6803 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame
))
6804 f
= last_mouse_frame
;
6806 f
= x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, event
.xbutton
.window
);
6809 if (f
&& xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f
, &event
))
6814 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6815 if (WINDOWP (f
->tool_bar_window
)
6816 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f
->tool_bar_window
)))
6819 int x
= event
.xbutton
.x
;
6820 int y
= event
.xbutton
.y
;
6822 window
= window_from_coordinates (f
, x
, y
, 0, 1);
6823 tool_bar_p
= EQ (window
, f
->tool_bar_window
);
6825 if (tool_bar_p
&& event
.xbutton
.button
< 4)
6827 handle_tool_bar_click (f
, x
, y
,
6828 event
.xbutton
.type
== ButtonPress
,
6829 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo
,
6830 event
.xbutton
.state
));
6835 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6836 if (! popup_activated ())
6839 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
)
6841 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
6842 && (int)(event
.xbutton
.time
- ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
) > 0)
6844 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6845 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6847 if (event
.type
== ButtonRelease
)
6848 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
6851 construct_mouse_click (&inev
.ie
, &event
.xbutton
, f
);
6853 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
6854 xembed_send_message (f
, event
.xbutton
.time
,
6855 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS
, 0, 0, 0);
6859 struct scroll_bar
*bar
6860 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event
.xbutton
.display
,
6861 event
.xbutton
.window
);
6863 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6864 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6866 if (bar
&& event
.xbutton
.state
& ControlMask
)
6868 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6869 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6871 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6873 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar
, &event
, &inev
.ie
);
6874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6877 if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6879 dpyinfo
->grabbed
|= (1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6880 last_mouse_frame
= f
;
6883 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
6886 dpyinfo
->grabbed
&= ~(1 << event
.xbutton
.button
);
6888 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6889 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6890 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6894 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6895 f
= x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6896 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6897 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6898 Instead, save it away
6899 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6900 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6901 if (! popup_activated ()
6903 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6904 && event
.xbutton
.button
< 3
6906 && f
&& event
.type
== ButtonPress
6907 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6908 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6909 && event
.xbutton
.x
>= 0
6910 && event
.xbutton
.x
< FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)
6911 && event
.xbutton
.y
>= 0
6912 && event
.xbutton
.y
< f
->output_data
.x
->menubar_height
6913 && event
.xbutton
.same_screen
)
6915 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT
;
6916 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame
, f
);
6917 *finish
= X_EVENT_DROP
;
6919 else if (event
.type
== ButtonPress
)
6921 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
6926 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6930 case CirculateNotify
:
6933 case CirculateRequest
:
6936 case VisibilityNotify
:
6940 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6942 switch (event
.xmapping
.request
)
6944 case MappingModifier
:
6945 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
6946 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6947 case MappingKeyboard
:
6948 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event
.xmapping
);
6953 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo
, &event
);
6958 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6960 if (*finish
!= X_EVENT_DROP
)
6961 XtDispatchEvent (&event
);
6963 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6968 if (inev
.ie
.kind
!= NO_EVENT
)
6970 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev
.ie
, hold_quit
);
6975 && !(hold_quit
&& hold_quit
->kind
!= NO_EVENT
))
6980 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
6986 any_help_event_p
= 1;
6987 gen_help_event (help_echo_string
, frame
, help_echo_window
,
6988 help_echo_object
, help_echo_pos
);
6992 help_echo_string
= Qnil
;
6993 gen_help_event (Qnil
, frame
, Qnil
, Qnil
, 0);
7002 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7004 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7005 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7006 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7008 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7010 x_dispatch_event (XEvent
*event
, Display
*display
)
7012 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
7013 int finish
= X_EVENT_NORMAL
;
7015 dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (display
);
7018 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo
, event
, &finish
, 0);
7025 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7026 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7027 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7029 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7030 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7031 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7034 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7037 XTread_socket (struct terminal
*terminal
, int expected
, struct input_event
*hold_quit
)
7040 int event_found
= 0;
7042 if (interrupt_input_blocked
)
7044 interrupt_input_pending
= 1;
7046 pending_signals
= 1;
7051 interrupt_input_pending
= 0;
7053 pending_signals
= pending_atimers
;
7057 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7058 input_signal_count
++;
7062 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7063 if (terminal
->display_info
.x
== XTread_socket_fake_io_error
)
7065 XTread_socket_fake_io_error
= 0;
7066 x_io_error_quitter (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
);
7070 while (XPending (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
))
7075 XNextEvent (terminal
->display_info
.x
->display
, &event
);
7078 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7079 if (x_filter_event (terminal
->display_info
.x
, &event
))
7084 count
+= handle_one_xevent (terminal
->display_info
.x
,
7085 &event
, &finish
, hold_quit
);
7087 if (finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7095 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7096 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7097 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7098 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7100 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7101 from all displays. */
7103 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7105 current_count
= count
;
7106 current_hold_quit
= hold_quit
;
7108 gtk_main_iteration ();
7110 count
= current_count
;
7112 current_hold_quit
= 0;
7114 if (current_finish
== X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT
)
7117 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7119 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7120 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7123 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7124 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7125 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7127 if (x_noop_count
>= 100)
7131 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== 0)
7132 next_noop_dpyinfo
= x_display_list
;
7134 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo
->display
);
7136 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7137 next_noop_dpyinfo
= next_noop_dpyinfo
->next
;
7141 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7143 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7144 if (pending_autoraise_frame
)
7146 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame
);
7147 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
7159 /***********************************************************************
7161 ***********************************************************************/
7163 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7164 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7166 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7167 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7168 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7171 x_clip_to_row (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int area
, GC gc
)
7173 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7174 XRectangle clip_rect
;
7175 int window_x
, window_y
, window_width
;
7177 window_box (w
, area
, &window_x
, &window_y
, &window_width
, 0);
7179 clip_rect
.x
= window_x
;
7180 clip_rect
.y
= WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, max (0, row
->y
));
7181 clip_rect
.y
= max (clip_rect
.y
, window_y
);
7182 clip_rect
.width
= window_width
;
7183 clip_rect
.height
= row
->visible_height
;
7185 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), gc
, 0, 0, &clip_rect
, 1, Unsorted
);
7189 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7192 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
)
7194 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7195 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
7196 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7199 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7202 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7203 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7204 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7205 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7208 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7209 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &x
, &y
, &h
);
7210 wd
= w
->phys_cursor_width
;
7212 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7213 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7214 xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7215 if (dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
)
7216 XChangeGC (dpy
, dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
, GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7218 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7219 GCForeground
, &xgcv
);
7220 gc
= dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7222 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7223 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7224 XDrawRectangle (dpy
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), gc
, x
, y
, wd
, h
- 1);
7225 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7229 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7231 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7232 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7233 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7237 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*row
, int width
, enum text_cursor_kinds kind
)
7239 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (w
->frame
);
7240 struct glyph
*cursor_glyph
;
7242 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7243 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7245 cursor_glyph
= get_phys_cursor_glyph (w
);
7246 if (cursor_glyph
== NULL
)
7249 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7250 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7251 the bar might not be in the window. */
7252 if (cursor_glyph
->type
== IMAGE_GLYPH
)
7254 struct glyph_row
*r
;
7255 r
= MATRIX_ROW (w
->current_matrix
, w
->phys_cursor
.vpos
);
7256 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, r
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7260 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
7261 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
7262 GC gc
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
;
7263 unsigned long mask
= GCForeground
| GCBackground
| GCGraphicsExposures
;
7264 struct face
*face
= FACE_FROM_ID (f
, cursor_glyph
->face_id
);
7267 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7268 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7269 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7270 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7271 that the glyph is legible. */
7272 if (face
->background
== f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
)
7273 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= face
->foreground
;
7275 xgcv
.background
= xgcv
.foreground
= f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
;
7276 xgcv
.graphics_exposures
= 0;
7279 XChangeGC (dpy
, gc
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7282 gc
= XCreateGC (dpy
, window
, mask
, &xgcv
);
7283 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->scratch_cursor_gc
= gc
;
7286 x_clip_to_row (w
, row
, TEXT_AREA
, gc
);
7288 if (kind
== BAR_CURSOR
)
7290 int x
= WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
);
7293 width
= FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f
);
7294 width
= min (cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
, width
);
7296 w
->phys_cursor_width
= width
;
7298 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7299 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7300 if ((cursor_glyph
->resolved_level
& 1) != 0)
7301 x
+= cursor_glyph
->pixel_width
- width
;
7303 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
, x
,
7304 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
),
7305 width
, row
->height
);
7309 int dummy_x
, dummy_y
, dummy_h
;
7312 width
= row
->height
;
7314 width
= min (row
->height
, width
);
7316 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w
, row
, cursor_glyph
, &dummy_x
,
7317 &dummy_y
, &dummy_h
);
7319 XFillRectangle (dpy
, window
, gc
,
7320 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.x
),
7321 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w
, w
->phys_cursor
.y
+
7322 row
->height
- width
),
7323 w
->phys_cursor_width
, width
);
7326 XSetClipMask (dpy
, gc
, None
);
7331 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7334 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame
*f
, Cursor cursor
)
7336 if (!f
->pointer_invisible
7337 && f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
!= cursor
)
7338 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
), cursor
);
7339 f
->output_data
.x
->current_cursor
= cursor
;
7343 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7346 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
, int width
, int height
)
7348 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
7349 x
, y
, width
, height
, False
);
7351 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7352 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
7353 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
));
7358 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7361 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window
*w
, struct glyph_row
*glyph_row
, int x
, int y
, int cursor_type
, int cursor_width
, int on_p
, int active_p
)
7363 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w
));
7367 w
->phys_cursor_type
= cursor_type
;
7368 w
->phys_cursor_on_p
= 1;
7370 if (glyph_row
->exact_window_width_line_p
7371 && (glyph_row
->reversed_p
7372 ? (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
< 0)
7373 : (w
->phys_cursor
.hpos
>= glyph_row
->used
[TEXT_AREA
])))
7375 glyph_row
->cursor_in_fringe_p
= 1;
7376 draw_fringe_bitmap (w
, glyph_row
, glyph_row
->reversed_p
);
7380 switch (cursor_type
)
7382 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR
:
7383 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w
, glyph_row
);
7386 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR
:
7387 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w
, glyph_row
, DRAW_CURSOR
);
7391 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, BAR_CURSOR
);
7395 x_draw_bar_cursor (w
, glyph_row
, cursor_width
, HBAR_CURSOR
);
7399 w
->phys_cursor_width
= 0;
7408 if (w
== XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
))
7409 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
))
7410 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, x
, y
);
7415 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
7422 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7425 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object file
)
7429 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7432 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7433 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7434 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7435 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7440 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7441 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7442 if (xg_set_icon (f
, file
))
7444 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7445 bitmap_id
= x_create_bitmap_from_file (f
, file
);
7446 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, bitmap_id
);
7450 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7451 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
< 0)
7457 if (xg_set_icon (f
, xg_default_icon_file
)
7458 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
))
7461 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7463 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f
, gnu_xpm_bits
);
7465 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7469 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7472 rc
= x_create_bitmap_from_data (f
, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits
,
7473 gnu_xbm_width
, gnu_xbm_height
);
7477 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
= rc
;
7478 x_create_bitmap_mask (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7482 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7483 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7484 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7485 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7486 x_reference_bitmap (f
, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
);
7488 bitmap_id
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->icon_bitmap_id
;
7491 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, bitmap_id
);
7492 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= bitmap_id
;
7498 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7499 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7502 x_text_icon (struct frame
*f
, const char *icon_name
)
7504 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) == 0)
7509 text
.value
= (unsigned char *) icon_name
;
7510 text
.encoding
= XA_STRING
;
7512 text
.nitems
= strlen (icon_name
);
7513 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &text
);
7516 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
> 0)
7517 x_destroy_bitmap (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
);
7518 f
->output_data
.x
->icon_bitmap
= 0;
7519 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f
, 0);
7524 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7526 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7527 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7529 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7530 be called from a signal handler.
7533 struct x_error_message_stack
{
7534 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7536 struct x_error_message_stack
*prev
;
7538 static struct x_error_message_stack
*x_error_message
;
7540 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7541 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7542 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7545 x_error_catcher (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7547 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
,
7548 x_error_message
->string
,
7549 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7552 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7553 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7556 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7557 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7558 stored in *x_error_message.
7560 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7561 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7563 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7566 x_catch_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7568 struct x_error_message_stack
*data
= xmalloc (sizeof (*data
));
7570 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7574 data
->string
[0] = 0;
7575 data
->prev
= x_error_message
;
7576 x_error_message
= data
;
7579 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7580 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7583 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7585 struct x_error_message_stack
*tmp
;
7589 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7590 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7591 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message
->dpy
) != 0)
7592 XSync (x_error_message
->dpy
, False
);
7594 tmp
= x_error_message
;
7595 x_error_message
= x_error_message
->prev
;
7600 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7601 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7602 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7605 x_check_errors (Display
*dpy
, const char *format
)
7607 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7610 if (x_error_message
->string
[0])
7612 char string
[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
];
7613 memcpy (string
, x_error_message
->string
, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE
);
7614 x_uncatch_errors ();
7615 error (format
, string
);
7619 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7620 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7623 x_had_errors_p (Display
*dpy
)
7625 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7628 return x_error_message
->string
[0] != 0;
7631 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7634 x_clear_errors (Display
*dpy
)
7636 x_error_message
->string
[0] = 0;
7639 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7640 * idea. --lorentey */
7641 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7644 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7646 while (x_error_message
)
7647 x_uncatch_errors ();
7651 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7654 x_catching_errors (void)
7656 return x_error_message
!= 0;
7660 static unsigned int x_wire_count
;
7663 fprintf (stderr
, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count
);
7668 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7669 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7670 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7671 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7672 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7675 x_connection_signal (int signalnum
) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7676 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7679 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7680 must reestablish each time */
7681 signal (signalnum
, x_connection_signal
);
7686 /************************************************************************
7688 ************************************************************************/
7690 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7692 static char *error_msg
;
7694 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7695 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7698 x_connection_closed (Display
*dpy
, const char *error_message
)
7700 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= x_display_info_for_display (dpy
);
7701 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7702 int idx
= SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7704 error_msg
= (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message
) + 1);
7705 strcpy (error_msg
, error_message
);
7706 handling_signal
= 0;
7708 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7709 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay
, Qt
);
7713 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7715 dpyinfo
->reference_count
++;
7716 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
++;
7719 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7720 that are on the dead display. */
7721 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7723 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame
;
7725 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame
))));
7726 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7727 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
))
7728 && ! EQ (frame
, minibuf_frame
)
7729 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7730 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7733 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7734 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7735 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7736 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7737 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame
))
7738 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
)) == dpyinfo
)
7740 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7741 trying to find a replacement. */
7742 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame
)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame
) = Qt
;
7743 delete_frame (frame
, Qnoelisp
);
7746 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7747 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7750 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7751 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7752 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7754 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7755 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7756 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7757 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7758 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil
);
7759 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n\
7760 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7761 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7762 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7765 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7767 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7768 dpyinfo
->display
= 0;
7770 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
7771 dpyinfo
->terminal
->reference_count
--;
7772 if (dpyinfo
->reference_count
!= 0)
7773 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7778 XSETTERMINAL (tmp
, dpyinfo
->terminal
);
7779 Fdelete_terminal (tmp
, Qnoelisp
);
7783 if (terminal_list
== 0)
7785 fprintf (stderr
, "%s\n", error_msg
);
7786 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7790 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7792 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO
));
7794 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM
));
7795 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT
;
7797 unbind_to (idx
, Qnil
);
7798 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7800 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7801 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list
) return; )
7803 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7804 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7805 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7806 error ("%s", error_msg
);
7809 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7810 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7811 static void x_error_quitter (Display
*, XErrorEvent
*);
7813 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7814 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7817 x_error_handler (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7819 if (x_error_message
)
7820 x_error_catcher (display
, event
);
7822 x_error_quitter (display
, event
);
7826 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7827 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7828 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7830 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7832 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7833 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7835 static void NO_INLINE
7836 x_error_quitter (Display
*display
, XErrorEvent
*event
)
7838 char buf
[256], buf1
[356];
7840 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7841 or colors that are not defined. */
7843 if (event
->error_code
== BadName
)
7846 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7847 original error handler. */
7849 XGetErrorText (display
, event
->error_code
, buf
, sizeof (buf
));
7850 sprintf (buf1
, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7851 buf
, event
->request_code
);
7852 x_connection_closed (display
, buf1
);
7856 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7857 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7858 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7861 x_io_error_quitter (Display
*display
)
7865 sprintf (buf
, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display
));
7866 x_connection_closed (display
, buf
);
7870 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7872 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7873 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7874 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7878 x_new_font (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object font_object
, int fontset
)
7880 struct font
*font
= XFONT_OBJECT (font_object
);
7883 fontset
= fontset_from_font (font_object
);
7884 FRAME_FONTSET (f
) = fontset
;
7885 if (FRAME_FONT (f
) == font
)
7886 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7890 FRAME_FONT (f
) = font
;
7891 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f
) = font
->baseline_offset
;
7892 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) = font
->average_width
;
7893 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f
) = font
->space_width
;
7894 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) = FONT_HEIGHT (font
);
7896 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 1);
7898 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7899 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) > 0)
7901 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7902 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
)
7903 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f
) + wid
-1) / wid
;
7907 int wid
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
7908 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) = (14 + wid
- 1) / wid
;
7911 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
) != 0)
7913 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7914 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7915 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7916 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
7917 x_set_window_size (f
, 0, FRAME_COLS (f
), FRAME_LINES (f
));
7922 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & (XIMPreeditPosition
| XIMStatusArea
)))
7925 xic_set_xfontset (f
, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset
)));
7934 /***********************************************************************
7936 ***********************************************************************/
7942 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7943 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7944 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7947 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
7949 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) client_data
;
7950 Lisp_Object frame
, tail
;
7954 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7955 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
7957 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
7958 if (FRAME_X_P (f
) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == dpyinfo
)
7960 FRAME_XIC (f
) = NULL
;
7961 xic_free_xfontset (f
);
7965 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7966 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
7967 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
7971 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7974 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7975 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM
, ...);
7978 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7979 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7982 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
7990 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
7991 xim
= XOpenIM (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
, resource_name
,
7998 XIMCallback destroy
;
8001 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8002 XGetIMValues (xim
, XNQueryInputStyle
, &dpyinfo
->xim_styles
, NULL
);
8005 destroy
.callback
= xim_destroy_callback
;
8006 destroy
.client_data
= (XPointer
)dpyinfo
;
8007 XSetIMValues (xim
, XNDestroyCallback
, &destroy
, NULL
);
8013 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8014 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8020 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8021 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8022 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8023 when the callback was registered. */
8026 xim_instantiate_callback (Display
*display
, XPointer client_data
, XPointer call_data
)
8028 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) client_data
;
8029 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= xim_inst
->dpyinfo
;
8031 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8035 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, xim_inst
->resource_name
);
8037 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8038 as they have no XIC. */
8039 if (dpyinfo
->xim
&& dpyinfo
->reference_count
> 0)
8041 Lisp_Object tail
, frame
;
8044 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail
, frame
)
8046 struct frame
*f
= XFRAME (frame
);
8049 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
) == xim_inst
->dpyinfo
)
8050 if (FRAME_XIC (f
) == NULL
)
8052 create_frame_xic (f
);
8053 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMStatusArea
)
8054 xic_set_statusarea (f
);
8055 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f
) & XIMPreeditPosition
)
8057 struct window
*w
= XWINDOW (f
->selected_window
);
8058 xic_set_preeditarea (w
, w
->cursor
.x
, w
->cursor
.y
);
8067 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8070 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8071 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8072 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8073 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8076 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
, char *resource_name
)
8078 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8082 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8083 struct xim_inst_t
*xim_inst
;
8086 xim_inst
= (struct xim_inst_t
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t
));
8087 dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
= xim_inst
;
8088 xim_inst
->dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
;
8089 len
= strlen (resource_name
);
8090 xim_inst
->resource_name
= (char *) xmalloc (len
+ 1);
8091 memcpy (xim_inst
->resource_name
, resource_name
, len
+ 1);
8092 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8093 resource_name
, emacs_class
,
8094 xim_instantiate_callback
,
8095 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8096 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8097 least, hence the configure test. */
8098 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6
) xim_inst
);
8099 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8100 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
8101 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8103 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8107 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8110 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
8115 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8116 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8117 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->xrdb
,
8119 xim_instantiate_callback
, NULL
);
8120 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
->resource_name
);
8121 xfree (dpyinfo
->xim_callback_data
);
8122 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8123 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
8124 XCloseIM (dpyinfo
->xim
);
8125 dpyinfo
->xim
= NULL
;
8126 XFree (dpyinfo
->xim_styles
);
8128 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8131 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8135 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8136 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8139 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame
*f
)
8141 int flags
= f
->size_hint_flags
;
8143 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8144 is already for the top-left corner. */
8145 if (! ((flags
& XNegative
) || (flags
& YNegative
)))
8148 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8149 position that fits on the screen. */
8150 if (flags
& XNegative
)
8151 f
->left_pos
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8152 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) + f
->left_pos
;
8155 int height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8157 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8158 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8159 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8161 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8162 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8163 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8164 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8167 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8168 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8170 XtVaGetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->column_widget
, XtNheight
, &height
, NULL
);
8173 if (flags
& YNegative
)
8174 f
->top_pos
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
8175 - height
+ f
->top_pos
;
8178 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8179 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8180 so the flags should correspond. */
8181 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8184 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8185 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8186 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8187 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8188 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8191 x_set_offset (struct frame
*f
, register int xoff
, register int yoff
, int change_gravity
)
8193 int modified_top
, modified_left
;
8195 if (change_gravity
> 0)
8197 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->left_before_move
= f
->left_pos
;
8198 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->top_before_move
= f
->top_pos
;
8202 f
->size_hint_flags
&= ~ (XNegative
| YNegative
);
8204 f
->size_hint_flags
|= XNegative
;
8206 f
->size_hint_flags
|= YNegative
;
8207 f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8209 x_calc_absolute_position (f
);
8212 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8214 modified_left
= f
->left_pos
;
8215 modified_top
= f
->top_pos
;
8217 if (change_gravity
!= 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
)
8219 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8220 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8221 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8222 modified_left
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8223 modified_top
+= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8226 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8227 modified_left
, modified_top
);
8229 x_sync_with_move (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
,
8230 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8233 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8234 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8235 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8236 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8239 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8240 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8241 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8243 if (change_gravity
!= 0 &&
8244 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8245 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
== X_WMTYPE_A
8246 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
== 0
8247 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
== 0))))
8248 x_check_expected_move (f
, modified_left
, modified_top
);
8253 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8254 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8255 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8256 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8257 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8260 wm_supports (struct frame
*f
, Atom want_atom
)
8263 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8264 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8265 Window wmcheck_window
;
8266 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8267 Window target_window
= dpyinfo
->root_window
;
8268 long max_len
= 65536;
8269 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8270 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8271 Atom target_type
= XA_WINDOW
;
8275 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8276 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8277 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
,
8278 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8279 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8280 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8282 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_WINDOW
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8284 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8285 x_uncatch_errors ();
8290 wmcheck_window
= *(Window
*) tmp_data
;
8293 /* Check if window exists. */
8294 XSelectInput (dpy
, wmcheck_window
, StructureNotifyMask
);
8296 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8298 x_uncatch_errors ();
8303 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
!= wmcheck_window
)
8305 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8306 if (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
!= NULL
)
8307 XFree (dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
);
8308 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
8309 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
8310 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
8312 target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8314 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, target_window
,
8315 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
,
8316 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8317 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8318 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8320 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= XA_ATOM
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8322 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8323 x_uncatch_errors ();
8328 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= (Atom
*)tmp_data
;
8329 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= actual_size
;
8330 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= wmcheck_window
;
8335 for (i
= 0; rc
== 0 && i
< dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
; ++i
)
8336 rc
= dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
[i
] == want_atom
;
8338 x_uncatch_errors ();
8345 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame
, int add
, Atom atom
, Atom value
)
8347 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame
));
8349 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8350 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8352 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8354 (make_number (add
? 1 : 0),
8356 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom
),
8358 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value
), Qnil
)
8363 x_set_sticky (struct frame
*f
, Lisp_Object new_value
, Lisp_Object old_value
)
8366 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8368 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8370 set_wm_state (frame
, NILP (new_value
) ? 0 : 1,
8371 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
, None
);
8374 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8375 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8376 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8379 get_current_wm_state (struct frame
*f
,
8385 unsigned long actual_size
, bytes_remaining
;
8386 int i
, rc
, actual_format
;
8387 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8388 long max_len
= 65536;
8389 Display
*dpy
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
);
8390 unsigned char *tmp_data
= NULL
;
8391 Atom target_type
= XA_ATOM
;
8394 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8397 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
8398 rc
= XGetWindowProperty (dpy
, window
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
,
8399 0, max_len
, False
, target_type
,
8400 &actual_type
, &actual_format
, &actual_size
,
8401 &bytes_remaining
, &tmp_data
);
8403 if (rc
!= Success
|| actual_type
!= target_type
|| x_had_errors_p (dpy
))
8405 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8406 x_uncatch_errors ();
8411 x_uncatch_errors ();
8413 for (i
= 0; i
< actual_size
; ++i
)
8415 Atom a
= ((Atom
*)tmp_data
)[i
];
8416 if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
)
8418 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8419 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8421 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
;
8423 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
)
8425 if (*size_state
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
)
8426 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
;
8428 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
;
8430 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
)
8431 *size_state
= FULLSCREEN_BOTH
;
8432 else if (a
== dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
)
8436 if (tmp_data
) XFree (tmp_data
);
8440 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8443 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8445 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8446 int have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
);
8449 get_current_wm_state (f
, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
), &cur
, &dummy
);
8451 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8452 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8454 have_net_atom
= wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
);
8456 if (have_net_atom
&& cur
!= f
->want_fullscreen
)
8460 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8462 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8463 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8464 are sent at once. */
8465 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8467 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8468 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8469 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
)
8470 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8471 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8472 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8474 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8475 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8476 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8477 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8478 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8479 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8480 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
, None
);
8482 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8483 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
|| cur
== FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8484 || cur
== FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8485 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
,
8486 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
);
8487 if (cur
!= FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
)
8488 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
, None
);
8490 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8491 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8492 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8493 set_wm_state (frame
, 1, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8494 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8496 case FULLSCREEN_NONE
:
8497 if (cur
== FULLSCREEN_BOTH
)
8498 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
, None
);
8500 set_wm_state (frame
, 0, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
,
8501 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
);
8504 f
->want_fullscreen
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8508 return have_net_atom
;
8512 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f
)
8514 if (f
->async_visible
)
8517 x_check_fullscreen (f
);
8525 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame
*f
, XPropertyEvent
*event
)
8527 int value
= FULLSCREEN_NONE
;
8531 get_current_wm_state (f
, event
->window
, &value
, &sticky
);
8535 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8538 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8541 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8544 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8549 store_frame_param (f
, Qfullscreen
, lval
);
8550 store_frame_param (f
, Qsticky
, sticky
? Qt
: Qnil
);
8553 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8554 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8556 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame
*f
)
8558 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f
))
8561 if (f
->output_data
.x
->parent_desc
!= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->root_window
)
8562 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8564 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8565 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8566 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8568 if (f
->want_fullscreen
!= FULLSCREEN_NONE
)
8570 int width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
), height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8571 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8573 switch (f
->want_fullscreen
)
8575 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8576 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH
:
8577 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
:
8578 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8579 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8581 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
:
8582 width
= x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo
);
8584 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
:
8585 height
= x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo
);
8588 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8593 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8594 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8595 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8596 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8597 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8598 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8599 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8602 x_check_expected_move (struct frame
*f
, int expected_left
, int expected_top
)
8604 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8606 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8607 window manager window around the frame. */
8609 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8611 if (current_left
!= expected_left
|| current_top
!= expected_top
)
8613 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8618 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_A
;
8619 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
= expected_left
- current_left
;
8620 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
= expected_top
- current_top
;
8622 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8624 adjusted_left
= expected_left
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_left
;
8625 adjusted_top
= expected_top
+ FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->move_offset_top
;
8627 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8628 adjusted_left
, adjusted_top
);
8630 x_sync_with_move (f
, expected_left
, expected_top
, 0);
8633 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8634 frame's position. */
8636 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_B
;
8640 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8641 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8642 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8643 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8644 of an exact comparison. */
8647 x_sync_with_move (struct frame
*f
, int left
, int top
, int fuzzy
)
8651 while (count
++ < 50)
8653 int current_left
= 0, current_top
= 0;
8655 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8656 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8659 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8660 x_real_positions (f
, ¤t_left
, ¤t_top
);
8664 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8667 if (eabs (current_left
- left
) <= 10
8668 && eabs (current_top
- top
) <= 40)
8671 else if (current_left
== left
&& current_top
== top
)
8675 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8676 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8678 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil
, NULL
, 0);
8682 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8684 x_wait_for_event (struct frame
*f
, int eventtype
)
8686 int level
= interrupt_input_blocked
;
8689 EMACS_TIME tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
;
8690 int fd
= ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8692 pending_event_wait
.f
= f
;
8693 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= eventtype
;
8695 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8696 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8697 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo
, 0, 100000);
8698 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at
);
8699 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at
, tmo_at
, tmo
);
8701 while (pending_event_wait
.eventtype
)
8703 interrupt_input_pending
= 1;
8704 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT
;
8705 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8707 interrupt_input_blocked
= level
;
8712 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now
);
8713 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo
, tmo_at
, time_now
);
8715 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo
) || select (fd
+1, &fds
, NULL
, NULL
, &tmo
) == 0)
8716 break; /* Timeout */
8718 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
8719 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
8723 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8724 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8725 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8726 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8729 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8731 int pixelwidth
, pixelheight
;
8733 check_frame_size (f
, &rows
, &cols
);
8734 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8735 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f
)
8737 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
));
8739 compute_fringe_widths (f
, 0);
8741 pixelwidth
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, cols
)
8742 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f
);
8743 pixelheight
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, rows
)
8744 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8746 if (change_gravity
) f
->win_gravity
= NorthWestGravity
;
8747 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 0);
8748 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8749 pixelwidth
, pixelheight
);
8752 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8753 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8754 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8755 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8756 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f
);
8758 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8759 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8760 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8761 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8763 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8764 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8765 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8766 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8767 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8769 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8772 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8773 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8774 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8775 if (f
->async_visible
)
8776 x_wait_for_event (f
, ConfigureNotify
);
8779 change_frame_size (f
, rows
, cols
, 0, 1, 0);
8780 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
) = pixelwidth
;
8781 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
) = pixelheight
;
8787 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8788 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8789 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8790 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8793 x_set_window_size (struct frame
*f
, int change_gravity
, int cols
, int rows
)
8797 if (NILP (tip_frame
) || XFRAME (tip_frame
) != f
)
8801 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8802 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8803 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8804 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8805 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8806 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8807 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8808 int pixelh
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8809 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8810 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8812 pixelh
-= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
8814 r
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f
, pixelh
);
8815 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8816 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8817 f
->scroll_bar_actual_width
8818 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f
) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
8819 c
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f
, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
));
8820 change_frame_size (f
, r
, c
, 0, 1, 0);
8824 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f
))
8825 xg_frame_set_char_size (f
, cols
, rows
);
8827 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8828 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8830 x_set_window_size_1 (f
, change_gravity
, cols
, rows
);
8832 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8834 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8835 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f
->root_window
));
8837 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8838 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8839 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8840 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8841 cancel_mouse_face (f
);
8846 /* Mouse warping. */
8849 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame
*f
, int x
, int y
)
8853 pix_x
= FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f
, x
) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
) / 2;
8854 pix_y
= FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f
, y
) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
) / 2;
8856 if (pix_x
< 0) pix_x
= 0;
8857 if (pix_x
> FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
)) pix_x
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
8859 if (pix_y
< 0) pix_y
= 0;
8860 if (pix_y
> FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
)) pix_y
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
8864 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8865 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8869 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8872 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame
*f
, int pix_x
, int pix_y
)
8876 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), None
, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
),
8877 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x
, pix_y
);
8881 /* Raise frame F. */
8884 x_raise_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8887 if (f
->async_visible
)
8888 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8890 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8894 /* Lower frame F. */
8897 x_lower_frame (struct frame
*f
)
8899 if (f
->async_visible
)
8902 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
));
8903 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
8908 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8911 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f
)
8913 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8914 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8916 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8917 if (f
->async_visible
&& wm_supports (f
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
))
8920 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
8921 x_send_client_event (frame
, make_number (0), frame
,
8922 dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
,
8924 Fcons (make_number (1),
8925 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time
),
8931 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f
, int raise_flag
)
8939 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8941 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8943 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8945 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8948 xembed_set_info (struct frame
*f
, enum xembed_info flags
)
8950 unsigned long data
[2];
8951 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
8953 data
[0] = XEMBED_VERSION
;
8956 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
8957 dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
, dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
,
8958 32, PropModeReplace
, (unsigned char *) data
, 2);
8960 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8963 xembed_send_message (struct frame
*f
, Time t
, enum xembed_message msg
,
8964 long int detail
, long int data1
, long int data2
)
8968 event
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
8969 event
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
;
8970 event
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_XEMBED
;
8971 event
.xclient
.format
= 32;
8972 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = t
;
8973 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[1] = msg
;
8974 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[2] = detail
;
8975 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[3] = data1
;
8976 event
.xclient
.data
.l
[4] = data2
;
8978 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f
)->parent_desc
,
8979 False
, NoEventMask
, &event
);
8980 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), False
);
8983 /* Change of visibility. */
8985 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8986 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8987 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8988 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8989 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8990 finishes with it. */
8993 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame
*f
)
8996 int original_top
, original_left
;
8997 int retry_count
= 2;
9003 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9005 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9007 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9009 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9010 call x_set_offset a second time
9011 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9012 before the window gets really visible. */
9013 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9014 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9015 && ! f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
)
9016 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9018 f
->output_data
.x
->asked_for_visible
= 1;
9020 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9021 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, NormalState
);
9022 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9023 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9024 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9027 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9028 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9030 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9032 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9033 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9035 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9036 xembed_set_info (f
, XEMBED_MAPPED
);
9038 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9039 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9040 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9043 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9045 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9046 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9047 so that incoming events are handled. */
9051 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9052 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9053 will set it when they are handled. */
9054 int previously_visible
= f
->output_data
.x
->has_been_visible
;
9056 original_left
= f
->left_pos
;
9057 original_top
= f
->top_pos
;
9059 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9062 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9064 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9065 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9066 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9067 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9069 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9070 because the window manager may choose the position
9071 and we don't want to override it. */
9073 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9074 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9075 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
)
9076 && f
->win_gravity
== NorthWestGravity
9077 && previously_visible
)
9081 unsigned int width
, height
, border
, depth
;
9085 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9086 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9087 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9088 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9089 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9090 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9091 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9092 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9093 &rootw
, &x
, &y
, &width
, &height
, &border
, &depth
);
9095 if (original_left
!= x
|| original_top
!= y
)
9096 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
),
9097 original_left
, original_top
);
9102 XSETFRAME (frame
, f
);
9104 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9105 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9106 MapNotify at all.. */
9107 for (count
= input_signal_count
+ 10;
9108 input_signal_count
< count
&& !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
);)
9110 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9113 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9114 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9115 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9116 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9117 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9119 if (input_polling_used ())
9121 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9122 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9123 handler reset it. */
9124 int old_poll_suppress_count
= poll_suppress_count
;
9125 poll_suppress_count
= 1;
9126 poll_for_input_1 ();
9127 poll_suppress_count
= old_poll_suppress_count
;
9130 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9131 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9136 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9140 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9141 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9142 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9143 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9145 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
) && --retry_count
!= 0)
9150 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9152 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9155 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame
*f
)
9159 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9160 window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9162 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9163 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9164 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9168 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9169 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9170 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9171 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9172 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9173 x_wm_set_size_hint (f
, (long) 0, 1);
9176 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9177 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9180 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9181 xembed_set_info (f
, 0);
9186 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
,
9187 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
))))
9189 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9190 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9194 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9195 just by the event that we get from the server.
9196 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9197 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9198 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9200 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
) = 0;
9201 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9202 f
->async_iconified
= 0;
9209 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9212 x_iconify_frame (struct frame
*f
)
9214 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9219 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9220 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
== f
)
9221 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9223 if (f
->async_iconified
)
9228 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f
);
9230 type
= x_icon_type (f
);
9232 x_bitmap_icon (f
, type
);
9235 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
))
9237 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9238 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
));
9240 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f
)));
9243 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9244 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9250 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9252 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9254 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager
, Qt
))
9255 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9256 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9257 XtMapWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9258 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9259 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9260 so we have to record it here. */
9263 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9264 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9269 result
= XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9270 XtWindow (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
),
9271 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)));
9275 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9277 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9278 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9282 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9284 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9286 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9287 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9288 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
)
9289 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f
)
9290 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f
))
9291 x_set_offset (f
, f
->left_pos
, f
->top_pos
, 0);
9293 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9294 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9296 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9297 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9301 msg
.xclient
.window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9302 msg
.xclient
.type
= ClientMessage
;
9303 msg
.xclient
.message_type
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
)->Xatom_wm_change_state
;
9304 msg
.xclient
.format
= 32;
9305 msg
.xclient
.data
.l
[0] = IconicState
;
9307 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
),
9308 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
)),
9310 SubstructureRedirectMask
| SubstructureNotifyMask
,
9313 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL
;
9314 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9318 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9320 x_wm_set_window_state (f
, IconicState
);
9322 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f
))
9324 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9325 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9328 f
->async_iconified
= 1;
9329 f
->async_visible
= 0;
9331 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9333 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9337 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9340 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame
*f
)
9342 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9343 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
9344 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9346 struct scroll_bar
*b
;
9351 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9352 commands to the X server. */
9353 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
9355 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9356 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9358 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f
))
9359 free_frame_faces (f
);
9361 if (f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
)
9362 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), f
->output_data
.x
->icon_desc
);
9364 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9365 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9366 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9367 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9368 toolkit scroll bars. */
9369 for (bar
= FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f
); !NILP (bar
); bar
= b
->next
)
9371 b
= XSCROLL_BAR (bar
);
9372 x_scroll_bar_remove (b
);
9381 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9382 if (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
)
9384 XtDestroyWidget (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
);
9385 f
->output_data
.x
->widget
= NULL
;
9387 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9388 we are using a toolkit. */
9389 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9390 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9392 free_frame_menubar (f
);
9393 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9396 xg_free_frame_widgets (f
);
9397 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9399 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
))
9400 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
));
9401 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9403 unload_color (f
, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9404 unload_color (f
, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f
));
9405 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_pixel
);
9406 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->cursor_foreground_pixel
);
9407 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->border_pixel
);
9408 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->mouse_pixel
);
9410 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
!= -1)
9411 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_background_pixel
);
9412 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
!= -1)
9413 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel
);
9414 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9415 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9416 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9417 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel
);
9418 if (f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
!= -1)
9419 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel
);
9420 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9421 if (f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.allocated_p
)
9422 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->white_relief
.pixel
);
9423 if (f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.allocated_p
)
9424 unload_color (f
, f
->output_data
.x
->black_relief
.pixel
);
9427 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
));
9430 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
->saved_menu_event
);
9431 xfree (f
->output_data
.x
);
9432 f
->output_data
.x
= NULL
;
9434 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
)
9435 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
9436 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
)
9437 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
9438 if (f
== dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
)
9439 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
9441 if (f
== hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
)
9443 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
9444 = hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
9445 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
9446 = hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
9447 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
9448 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
9449 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
9456 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9459 x_destroy_window (struct frame
*f
)
9461 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
);
9463 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9464 commands to the X server. */
9465 if (dpyinfo
->display
!= 0)
9466 x_free_frame_resources (f
);
9468 dpyinfo
->reference_count
--;
9472 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9474 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9475 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9476 that the window now has.
9477 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9478 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9479 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9483 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame
*f
, long flags
, int user_position
)
9485 XSizeHints size_hints
;
9486 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9488 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9489 size_hints
.flags
= PResizeInc
| PMinSize
/* | PMaxSize */;
9491 size_hints
.x
= f
->left_pos
;
9492 size_hints
.y
= f
->top_pos
;
9494 size_hints
.height
= FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
);
9495 size_hints
.width
= FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
);
9497 size_hints
.width_inc
= FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f
);
9498 size_hints
.height_inc
= FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f
);
9499 size_hints
.max_width
= x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9500 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9501 size_hints
.max_height
= x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f
))
9502 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9504 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9506 int base_width
, base_height
;
9507 int min_rows
= 0, min_cols
= 0;
9509 base_width
= FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f
, 0);
9510 base_height
= FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f
, 0);
9512 check_frame_size (f
, &min_rows
, &min_cols
);
9514 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9515 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9516 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9517 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9518 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9520 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9521 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9522 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9524 size_hints
.flags
|= PBaseSize
;
9525 size_hints
.base_width
= base_width
;
9526 size_hints
.base_height
= base_height
+ FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f
);
9527 size_hints
.min_width
= base_width
+ min_cols
* size_hints
.width_inc
;
9528 size_hints
.min_height
= base_height
+ min_rows
* size_hints
.height_inc
;
9531 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9534 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9539 XSizeHints hints
; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9540 long supplied_return
;
9543 value
= XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &hints
,
9547 size_hints
.flags
|= flags
;
9552 if (hints
.flags
& PSize
)
9553 size_hints
.flags
|= PSize
;
9554 if (hints
.flags
& PPosition
)
9555 size_hints
.flags
|= PPosition
;
9556 if (hints
.flags
& USPosition
)
9557 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9558 if (hints
.flags
& USSize
)
9559 size_hints
.flags
|= USSize
;
9566 size_hints
.win_gravity
= f
->win_gravity
;
9567 size_hints
.flags
|= PWinGravity
;
9571 size_hints
.flags
&= ~ PPosition
;
9572 size_hints
.flags
|= USPosition
;
9574 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9576 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &size_hints
);
9578 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9580 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9583 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame
*f
, int state
)
9585 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9588 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNinitialState
, state
);
9589 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9590 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9591 Window window
= FRAME_X_WINDOW (f
);
9593 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= StateHint
;
9594 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.initial_state
= state
;
9596 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9597 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9601 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame
*f
, int pixmap_id
)
9603 Pixmap icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
;
9605 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9606 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9611 icon_pixmap
= x_bitmap_pixmap (f
, pixmap_id
);
9612 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_pixmap
= icon_pixmap
;
9613 icon_mask
= x_bitmap_mask (f
, pixmap_id
);
9614 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_mask
= icon_mask
;
9618 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9626 xg_set_frame_icon (f
, icon_pixmap
, icon_mask
);
9630 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9634 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconPixmap
, icon_pixmap
);
9635 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9636 XtSetArg (al
[0], XtNiconMask
, icon_mask
);
9637 XtSetValues (f
->output_data
.x
->widget
, al
, 1);
9640 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9642 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= (IconPixmapHint
| IconMaskHint
);
9643 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9645 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9649 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame
*f
, int icon_x
, int icon_y
)
9651 Window window
= FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f
);
9653 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.flags
|= IconPositionHint
;
9654 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_x
= icon_x
;
9655 f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
.icon_y
= icon_y
;
9657 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f
), window
, &f
->output_data
.x
->wm_hints
);
9661 /***********************************************************************
9663 ***********************************************************************/
9667 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9671 x_check_font (struct frame
*f
, struct font
*font
)
9675 xassert (font
!= NULL
&& ! NILP (font
->props
[FONT_TYPE_INDEX
]));
9676 if (font
->driver
->check
)
9677 xassert (font
->driver
->check (f
, font
) == 0);
9680 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9683 /***********************************************************************
9685 ***********************************************************************/
9687 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9688 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options
[] = {
9689 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9690 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg
, (XtPointer
) "yes"},
9692 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9693 XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9694 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg
, NULL
},
9696 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9697 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9698 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9699 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9700 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9701 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
},
9702 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg
, (XtPointer
) NULL
}
9705 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9707 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
;
9709 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9711 static int x_initialized
;
9713 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9714 the screen number from the server number. */
9716 same_x_server (const char *name1
, const char *name2
)
9719 const char *system_name
= SSDATA (Vsystem_name
);
9720 int system_name_length
= strlen (system_name
);
9721 int length_until_period
= 0;
9723 while (system_name
[length_until_period
] != 0
9724 && system_name
[length_until_period
] != '.')
9725 length_until_period
++;
9727 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9728 if (! strncmp (name1
, "unix:", 5))
9730 if (! strncmp (name2
, "unix:", 5))
9732 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9733 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9734 && name1
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9735 name1
+= system_name_length
;
9736 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, system_name_length
)
9737 && name2
[system_name_length
] == ':')
9738 name2
+= system_name_length
;
9739 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9740 if (! strncmp (name1
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9741 && name1
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9742 name1
+= length_until_period
;
9743 if (! strncmp (name2
, system_name
, length_until_period
)
9744 && name2
[length_until_period
] == ':')
9745 name2
+= length_until_period
;
9747 for (; *name1
!= '\0' && *name1
== *name2
; name1
++, name2
++)
9751 if (seen_colon
&& *name1
== '.')
9755 && (*name1
== '.' || *name1
== '\0')
9756 && (*name2
== '.' || *name2
== '\0'));
9759 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9760 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9763 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask
, int *bits
, int *offset
)
9784 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9785 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9788 x_display_ok (const char *display
)
9793 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (display
);
9795 XCloseDisplay (dpy
);
9803 my_log_handler (const gchar
*log_domain
, GLogLevelFlags log_level
,
9804 const gchar
*msg
, gpointer user_data
)
9806 if (!strstr (msg
, "g_set_prgname"))
9807 fprintf (stderr
, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain
, msg
);
9811 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9812 the structure that describes the open display.
9813 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9815 struct x_display_info
*
9816 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name
, char *xrm_option
, char *resource_name
)
9820 struct terminal
*terminal
;
9821 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
;
9823 Mouse_HLInfo
*hlinfo
;
9833 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name
)))
9834 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name
));
9840 char *argv
[NUM_ARGV
];
9841 char **argv2
= argv
;
9844 if (x_initialized
++ > 1)
9846 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name
), &dpy
);
9850 static char display_opt
[] = "--display";
9851 static char name_opt
[] = "--name";
9853 for (argc
= 0; argc
< NUM_ARGV
; ++argc
)
9857 argv
[argc
++] = initial_argv
[0];
9859 if (! NILP (display_name
))
9861 argv
[argc
++] = display_opt
;
9862 argv
[argc
++] = SSDATA (display_name
);
9865 argv
[argc
++] = name_opt
;
9866 argv
[argc
++] = resource_name
;
9868 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9870 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9871 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9873 static char fix_events
[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9874 putenv (fix_events
);
9877 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9878 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9879 id
= g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING
| G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9880 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION
, my_log_handler
, NULL
);
9881 gtk_init (&argc
, &argv2
);
9882 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id
);
9884 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9888 dpy
= DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9890 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9891 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL
, event_handler_gdk
, NULL
);
9893 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9894 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9896 const char *file
= "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9897 Lisp_Object s
, abs_file
;
9899 s
= make_string (file
, strlen (file
));
9900 abs_file
= Fexpand_file_name (s
, Qnil
);
9902 if (! NILP (abs_file
) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file
)))
9903 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file
));
9907 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
9908 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
9911 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9912 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9913 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9915 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9916 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9917 So let's not use it until R6. */
9919 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL
, NULL
, NULL
);
9930 argv
[argc
++] = "-xrm";
9931 argv
[argc
++] = xrm_option
;
9933 turn_on_atimers (0);
9934 dpy
= XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con
, SSDATA (display_name
),
9935 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
,
9936 emacs_options
, XtNumber (emacs_options
),
9938 turn_on_atimers (1);
9941 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9946 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9947 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9948 dpy
= XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name
));
9949 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9950 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9952 /* Detect failure. */
9959 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9961 dpyinfo
= (struct x_display_info
*) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info
));
9962 memset (dpyinfo
, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo
);
9963 hlinfo
= &dpyinfo
->mouse_highlight
;
9965 terminal
= x_create_terminal (dpyinfo
);
9968 struct x_display_info
*share
;
9971 for (share
= x_display_list
, tail
= x_display_name_list
; share
;
9972 share
= share
->next
, tail
= XCDR (tail
))
9973 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail
))),
9974 SSDATA (display_name
)))
9977 terminal
->kboard
= share
->terminal
->kboard
;
9980 terminal
->kboard
= (KBOARD
*) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD
));
9981 init_kboard (terminal
->kboard
);
9982 KVAR (terminal
->kboard
, Vwindow_system
) = Qx
;
9984 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9985 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9986 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9987 terminal
->kboard
->next_kboard
= all_kboards
;
9988 all_kboards
= terminal
->kboard
;
9990 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
)->function
, Qunbound
))
9992 char *vendor
= ServerVendor (dpy
);
9994 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9995 list of terminals. */
9996 struct gcpro gcpro1
;
9997 Lisp_Object gcpro_term
;
9998 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term
, terminal
);
9999 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term
);
10001 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10002 terminal_list
= terminal
->next_terminal
;
10004 KVAR (terminal
->kboard
, Vsystem_key_alist
)
10005 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms
,
10006 vendor
? build_string (vendor
) : empty_unibyte_string
);
10008 terminal
->next_terminal
= terminal_list
;
10009 terminal_list
= terminal
;
10013 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10014 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10015 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10016 if (current_kboard
== initial_kboard
)
10017 current_kboard
= terminal
->kboard
;
10019 terminal
->kboard
->reference_count
++;
10022 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10023 dpyinfo
->next
= x_display_list
;
10024 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
;
10026 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10027 x_display_name_list
= Fcons (Fcons (display_name
, Qnil
),
10028 x_display_name_list
);
10029 dpyinfo
->name_list_element
= XCAR (x_display_name_list
);
10031 dpyinfo
->display
= dpy
;
10033 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10034 terminal
->name
= (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name
) + 1);
10035 strncpy (terminal
->name
, SSDATA (display_name
), SBYTES (display_name
));
10036 terminal
->name
[SBYTES (display_name
)] = 0;
10039 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display
, x_trace_wire
);
10043 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name
)
10044 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name
)
10046 sprintf (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
, "%s@%s",
10047 SSDATA (Vinvocation_name
), SSDATA (Vsystem_name
));
10049 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10050 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo
);
10052 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10054 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10055 dpyinfo
->xg_cursor
= xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo
->display
);
10056 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10058 dpyinfo
->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10059 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo
->display
, XC_sb_v_double_arrow
);
10061 xrdb
= x_load_resources (dpyinfo
->display
, xrm_option
,
10062 resource_name
, EMACS_CLASS
);
10063 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10064 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, xrdb
);
10066 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= xrdb
;
10068 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10070 dpyinfo
->xrdb
= xrdb
;
10072 dpyinfo
->screen
= ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
,
10073 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo
->display
));
10074 select_visual (dpyinfo
);
10075 dpyinfo
->cmap
= DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10076 dpyinfo
->root_window
= RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10077 dpyinfo
->client_leader_window
= 0;
10078 dpyinfo
->grabbed
= 0;
10079 dpyinfo
->reference_count
= 0;
10080 dpyinfo
->icon_bitmap_id
= -1;
10081 dpyinfo
->n_fonts
= 0;
10082 dpyinfo
->bitmaps
= 0;
10083 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_size
= 0;
10084 dpyinfo
->bitmaps_last
= 0;
10085 dpyinfo
->scratch_cursor_gc
= 0;
10086 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_frame
= 0;
10087 hlinfo
->mouse_face_deferred_gc
= 0;
10088 hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_beg_col
= -1;
10089 hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_row
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_end_col
= -1;
10090 hlinfo
->mouse_face_face_id
= DEFAULT_FACE_ID
;
10091 hlinfo
->mouse_face_window
= Qnil
;
10092 hlinfo
->mouse_face_overlay
= Qnil
;
10093 hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_x
= hlinfo
->mouse_face_mouse_y
= 0;
10094 hlinfo
->mouse_face_defer
= 0;
10095 hlinfo
->mouse_face_hidden
= 0;
10096 dpyinfo
->x_focus_frame
= 0;
10097 dpyinfo
->x_focus_event_frame
= 0;
10098 dpyinfo
->x_highlight_frame
= 0;
10099 dpyinfo
->wm_type
= X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
;
10101 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10102 dpyinfo
->red_bits
= dpyinfo
->blue_bits
= dpyinfo
->green_bits
= 0;
10103 dpyinfo
->red_offset
= dpyinfo
->blue_offset
= dpyinfo
->green_offset
= 0;
10105 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == TrueColor
)
10107 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->red_mask
,
10108 &dpyinfo
->red_bits
, &dpyinfo
->red_offset
);
10109 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->blue_mask
,
10110 &dpyinfo
->blue_bits
, &dpyinfo
->blue_offset
);
10111 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo
->visual
->green_mask
,
10112 &dpyinfo
->green_bits
, &dpyinfo
->green_offset
);
10115 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10116 if (dpyinfo
->visual
== DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
))
10118 if (dpyinfo
->visual
->class == PseudoColor
)
10121 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10122 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10123 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10125 if (STRINGP (value
)
10126 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10127 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10128 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->cmap
);
10132 dpyinfo
->cmap
= XCreateColormap (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10133 dpyinfo
->visual
, AllocNone
);
10137 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10138 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10139 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10140 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10141 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10143 char *v
= XGetDefault (dpyinfo
->display
, "Xft", "dpi");
10145 if (v
!= NULL
&& sscanf (v
, "%lf", &d
) == 1)
10146 dpyinfo
->resy
= dpyinfo
->resx
= d
;
10150 if (dpyinfo
->resy
< 1)
10152 int screen_number
= XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
);
10153 double pixels
= DisplayHeight (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10154 double mm
= DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10155 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10156 dpyinfo
->resy
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10157 pixels
= DisplayWidth (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10158 mm
= DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo
->display
, screen_number
);
10159 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10160 dpyinfo
->resx
= (mm
< 1) ? 100 : pixels
* 25.4 / mm
;
10169 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_protocols
},
10170 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_take_focus
},
10171 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
},
10172 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_delete_window
},
10173 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_change_state
},
10174 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
},
10175 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_window_moved
},
10176 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_wm_client_leader
},
10177 { "Editres", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_editres
},
10178 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
},
10179 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
},
10180 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TEXT
},
10181 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
},
10182 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
},
10183 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_DELETE
},
10184 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULTIPLE
},
10185 { "INCR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_INCR
},
10186 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
},
10187 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_TARGETS
},
10188 { "NULL", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_NULL
},
10189 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
},
10190 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO
},
10191 /* For properties of font. */
10192 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
},
10193 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
},
10194 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
},
10195 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
},
10196 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
},
10197 /* Ghostscript support. */
10198 { "DONE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_DONE
},
10199 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_PAGE
},
10200 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_Scrollbar
},
10201 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_XEMBED
},
10203 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state
},
10204 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen
},
10205 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10206 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
},
10207 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10208 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
},
10209 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
},
10210 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_window_type
},
10211 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10212 &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
},
10213 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
},
10214 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_name
},
10215 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supported
},
10216 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check
},
10217 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity
},
10218 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_active_window
},
10219 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_net_frame_extents
},
10220 /* Session management */
10221 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID
},
10222 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_prop
},
10223 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_mgr
},
10227 const int atom_count
= sizeof (atom_refs
) / sizeof (atom_refs
[0]);
10228 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10229 const int total_atom_count
= 1 + atom_count
;
10230 Atom
*atoms_return
= xmalloc (sizeof (Atom
) * total_atom_count
);
10231 char **atom_names
= xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count
);
10232 char xsettings_atom_name
[64];
10234 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10235 atom_names
[i
] = (char *) atom_refs
[i
].name
;
10237 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10238 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name
, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name
),
10239 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo
->screen
));
10240 atom_names
[i
] = xsettings_atom_name
;
10242 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo
->display
, atom_names
, total_atom_count
,
10243 False
, atoms_return
);
10245 for (i
= 0; i
< atom_count
; i
++)
10246 *atom_refs
[i
].atom
= atoms_return
[i
];
10248 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10249 dpyinfo
->Xatom_xsettings_sel
= atoms_return
[i
];
10251 xfree (atom_names
);
10252 xfree (atoms_return
);
10255 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
= 8;
10256 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_length
= 0;
10257 dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
= xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
)
10258 * dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms_size
);
10260 dpyinfo
->net_supported_atoms
= NULL
;
10261 dpyinfo
->nr_net_supported_atoms
= 0;
10262 dpyinfo
->net_supported_window
= 0;
10264 connection
= ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo
->display
);
10265 dpyinfo
->connection
= connection
;
10269 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo
->display
, dpyinfo
->root_window
,
10271 gray_bitmap_width
, gray_bitmap_height
,
10272 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10276 xim_initialize (dpyinfo
, resource_name
);
10279 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10281 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10282 if (connection
!= 0)
10283 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection
);
10286 fcntl (connection
, F_SETOWN
, getpid ());
10287 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10290 if (interrupt_input
)
10291 init_sigio (connection
);
10292 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10296 XrmValue d
, fr
, to
;
10299 dpy
= dpyinfo
->display
;
10300 d
.addr
= (XPointer
)&dpy
;
10301 d
.size
= sizeof (Display
*);
10302 fr
.addr
= XtDefaultFont
;
10303 fr
.size
= sizeof (XtDefaultFont
);
10304 to
.size
= sizeof (Font
*);
10305 to
.addr
= (XPointer
)&font
;
10306 x_catch_errors (dpy
);
10307 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy
, XtCvtStringToFont
, &d
, 1, &fr
, &to
, NULL
))
10309 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy
) || !XQueryFont (dpy
, font
))
10310 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb
, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10311 x_uncatch_errors ();
10315 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10316 for debugging X code. */
10319 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10320 build_string ("synchronous"),
10321 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10323 if (STRINGP (value
)
10324 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10325 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10326 XSynchronize (dpyinfo
->display
, True
);
10331 value
= display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo
,
10332 build_string ("useXIM"),
10333 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10336 if (STRINGP (value
)
10337 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "false")
10338 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "off")))
10341 if (STRINGP (value
)
10342 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "true")
10343 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value
), "on")))
10349 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10350 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10352 if (terminal
->id
== 1)
10353 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo
);
10361 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10362 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10365 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10367 struct terminal
*t
;
10369 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10371 for (t
= terminal_list
; t
; t
= t
->next_terminal
)
10372 if (t
->type
== output_x_window
&& t
->display_info
.x
== dpyinfo
)
10375 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10376 if (t
->id
== 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10377 x_session_close ();
10379 delete_terminal (t
);
10383 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo
->connection
);
10385 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10386 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10387 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list
)
10388 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list
), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10389 x_display_name_list
= XCDR (x_display_name_list
);
10394 tail
= x_display_name_list
;
10395 while (CONSP (tail
) && CONSP (XCDR (tail
)))
10397 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail
)), dpyinfo
->name_list_element
))
10399 XSETCDR (tail
, XCDR (XCDR (tail
)));
10402 tail
= XCDR (tail
);
10406 if (next_noop_dpyinfo
== dpyinfo
)
10407 next_noop_dpyinfo
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10409 if (x_display_list
== dpyinfo
)
10410 x_display_list
= dpyinfo
->next
;
10413 struct x_display_info
*tail
;
10415 for (tail
= x_display_list
; tail
; tail
= tail
->next
)
10416 if (tail
->next
== dpyinfo
)
10417 tail
->next
= tail
->next
->next
;
10420 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_id_name
);
10421 xfree (dpyinfo
->x_dnd_atoms
);
10422 xfree (dpyinfo
->color_cells
);
10426 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10428 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10429 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10430 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10431 that slows us down. */
10434 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer
*timer
)
10437 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 0;
10438 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction
|| popup_activated ())
10440 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con
) & XtIMTimer
)
10441 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con
, XtIMTimer
);
10442 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10443 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10448 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10449 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10450 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10451 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10452 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10453 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10454 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10457 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10460 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
)
10462 EMACS_TIME interval
;
10464 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval
, 0, 100000);
10465 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE
, interval
, x_process_timeouts
, 0);
10466 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag
= 1;
10471 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10474 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10476 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers
[];
10478 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface
=
10480 x_frame_parm_handlers
,
10484 x_clear_end_of_line
,
10486 x_after_update_window_line
,
10487 x_update_window_begin
,
10488 x_update_window_end
,
10494 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10496 x_clear_window_mouse_face
,
10497 x_get_glyph_overhangs
,
10498 x_fix_overlapping_area
,
10499 x_draw_fringe_bitmap
,
10500 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10501 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10502 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs
,
10503 x_draw_glyph_string
,
10504 x_define_frame_cursor
,
10505 x_clear_frame_area
,
10506 x_draw_window_cursor
,
10507 x_draw_vertical_window_border
,
10508 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10512 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10514 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal
*terminal
)
10516 struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
= terminal
->display_info
.x
;
10518 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10519 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10520 if (!terminal
->name
)
10525 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10528 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo
);
10531 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10532 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10533 if (dpyinfo
->display
)
10535 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo
);
10536 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo
->display
, DestroyAll
);
10538 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10539 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10540 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10541 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10543 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10544 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10545 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10546 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10547 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10548 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10549 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10550 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10551 leaks in other situations. */
10553 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10554 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo
->display
, NULL
);
10556 dpyinfo
->display
->db
= NULL
;
10558 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10559 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10560 closing all the displays. */
10561 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo
->xrdb
);
10565 xg_display_close (dpyinfo
->display
);
10567 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10568 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10570 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo
->display
);
10572 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10575 /* Mark as dead. */
10576 dpyinfo
->display
= NULL
;
10577 x_delete_display (dpyinfo
);
10581 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10582 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10584 static struct terminal
*
10585 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info
*dpyinfo
)
10587 struct terminal
*terminal
;
10589 terminal
= create_terminal ();
10591 terminal
->type
= output_x_window
;
10592 terminal
->display_info
.x
= dpyinfo
;
10593 dpyinfo
->terminal
= terminal
;
10595 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10597 terminal
->clear_frame_hook
= x_clear_frame
;
10598 terminal
->ins_del_lines_hook
= x_ins_del_lines
;
10599 terminal
->delete_glyphs_hook
= x_delete_glyphs
;
10600 terminal
->ring_bell_hook
= XTring_bell
;
10601 terminal
->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook
= XTtoggle_invisible_pointer
;
10602 terminal
->reset_terminal_modes_hook
= XTreset_terminal_modes
;
10603 terminal
->set_terminal_modes_hook
= XTset_terminal_modes
;
10604 terminal
->update_begin_hook
= x_update_begin
;
10605 terminal
->update_end_hook
= x_update_end
;
10606 terminal
->set_terminal_window_hook
= XTset_terminal_window
;
10607 terminal
->read_socket_hook
= XTread_socket
;
10608 terminal
->frame_up_to_date_hook
= XTframe_up_to_date
;
10609 terminal
->mouse_position_hook
= XTmouse_position
;
10610 terminal
->frame_rehighlight_hook
= XTframe_rehighlight
;
10611 terminal
->frame_raise_lower_hook
= XTframe_raise_lower
;
10612 terminal
->fullscreen_hook
= XTfullscreen_hook
;
10613 terminal
->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook
= XTset_vertical_scroll_bar
;
10614 terminal
->condemn_scroll_bars_hook
= XTcondemn_scroll_bars
;
10615 terminal
->redeem_scroll_bar_hook
= XTredeem_scroll_bar
;
10616 terminal
->judge_scroll_bars_hook
= XTjudge_scroll_bars
;
10618 terminal
->delete_frame_hook
= x_destroy_window
;
10619 terminal
->delete_terminal_hook
= x_delete_terminal
;
10621 terminal
->rif
= &x_redisplay_interface
;
10622 terminal
->scroll_region_ok
= 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10623 terminal
->char_ins_del_ok
= 1;
10624 terminal
->line_ins_del_ok
= 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10625 terminal
->fast_clear_end_of_line
= 1; /* X does this well. */
10626 terminal
->memory_below_frame
= 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10633 x_initialize (void)
10638 last_tool_bar_item
= -1;
10639 any_help_event_p
= 0;
10640 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout
= 0;
10643 current_count
= -1;
10646 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10647 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt
);
10649 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10650 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10652 Xt_app_con
= XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10654 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10655 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10656 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con
,
10657 XtRString
, XtRPixel
, cvt_string_to_pixel
,
10658 cvt_string_to_pixel_args
,
10659 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args
),
10660 XtCacheByDisplay
, cvt_pixel_dtor
);
10662 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con
, Xt_default_resources
);
10665 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10667 xaw3d_arrow_scroll
= False
;
10668 xaw3d_pick_top
= True
;
10672 pending_autoraise_frame
= 0;
10673 pending_event_wait
.f
= 0;
10674 pending_event_wait
.eventtype
= 0;
10676 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10677 original error handler. */
10678 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler
);
10679 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter
);
10681 signal (SIGPIPE
, x_connection_signal
);
10683 xgselect_initialize ();
10688 syms_of_xterm (void)
10690 x_error_message
= NULL
;
10692 staticpro (&x_display_name_list
);
10693 x_display_name_list
= Qnil
;
10695 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar
);
10696 last_mouse_scroll_bar
= Qnil
;
10698 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms
);
10699 Qvendor_specific_keysyms
= intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10701 staticpro (&Qlatin_1
);
10702 Qlatin_1
= intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10704 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame
);
10705 last_mouse_press_frame
= Qnil
;
10708 xg_default_icon_file
= make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10709 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file
);
10711 Qx_gtk_map_stock
= intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10712 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock
);
10715 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10716 x_use_underline_position_properties
,
10717 doc
: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10718 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10719 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10720 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10721 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10723 x_use_underline_position_properties
= 1;
10725 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10726 x_underline_at_descent_line
,
10727 doc
: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10728 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10729 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10730 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10731 x_underline_at_descent_line
= 0;
10733 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10734 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
,
10735 doc
: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10736 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10737 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10738 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10739 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10740 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10741 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position
= 0;
10743 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
,
10744 doc
: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10745 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10746 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10747 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10748 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10749 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10751 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("motif");
10752 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10753 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10755 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("gtk");
10757 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= intern_c_string ("xaw");
10760 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars
= Qnil
;
10763 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame
);
10764 last_mouse_motion_frame
= Qnil
;
10766 Qmodifier_value
= intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10767 Qalt
= intern_c_string ("alt");
10768 Fput (Qalt
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (alt_modifier
));
10769 Qhyper
= intern_c_string ("hyper");
10770 Fput (Qhyper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (hyper_modifier
));
10771 Qmeta
= intern_c_string ("meta");
10772 Fput (Qmeta
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (meta_modifier
));
10773 Qsuper
= intern_c_string ("super");
10774 Fput (Qsuper
, Qmodifier_value
, make_number (super_modifier
));
10776 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym
,
10777 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10778 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10779 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10780 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10781 Vx_alt_keysym
= Qnil
;
10783 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym
,
10784 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10785 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10786 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10787 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10788 Vx_hyper_keysym
= Qnil
;
10790 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym
,
10791 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10792 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10793 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10794 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10795 Vx_meta_keysym
= Qnil
;
10797 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym
,
10798 doc
: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10799 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10800 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10801 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10802 Vx_super_keysym
= Qnil
;
10804 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table
,
10805 doc
: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10806 Vx_keysym_table
= make_hash_table (Qeql
, make_number (900),
10807 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE
),
10808 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD
),
10812 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */